blob: a928eba1800cb919a653c2a4ac3ae9c55d7f43f1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet4764f0e2021-04-23 18:51:30 +02007 2021/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand83972542020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700408 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001084 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001282 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1283 field is stripped. This is the default.
1284 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1285 rfc3164.
1286
1287 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001288 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1289
1290 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1291 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1292
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001293 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1294 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1295 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1296 designed to be used with a local log server.
1297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001298 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1299 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1300 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1301 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1302 logger consumes.
1303
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001304 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1305 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1306 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1307 used with a local log server.
1308
1309 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1310 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1311 designed to be used with a local log server.
1312
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001313 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1315 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1316 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1317
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001318 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1319 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1320 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1321 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1322 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1323
1324 <sample_size>
1325 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1326 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1327 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1328 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1329 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1330
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001331 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001333 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1334 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1335 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1336
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001337 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1338 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1339 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1340 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341
1342 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001343 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1344 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1345 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1346 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1347 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1348 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001351
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001352log-send-hostname [<string>]
1353 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1354 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1355 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1356 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1357 the logs.
1358
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359log-tag <string>
1360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1361 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1362 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001363 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001364
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001365lua-load <file>
1366 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1367 used multiple times.
1368
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001369lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1370 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1371 variable.
1372 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1373 to "path".
1374
1375 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1376 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1377 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1378 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1379 will be checked earlier.
1380
1381 As an example by specifying the following path:
1382
1383 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1384 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1385
1386 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1387 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1388 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1389 paths if that does not exist either.
1390
1391 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1392 documentation.
1393
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001394master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001395 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1396 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1397 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001399 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1400 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001401 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1402 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1403 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1404 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1405 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001406
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001407 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001408
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001409mworker-max-reloads <number>
1410 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001411 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001412 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1413 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1414 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1415
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001416nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1418 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1419 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001420 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1421 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001422 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1423 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1424 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001425
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001426nbthread <number>
1427 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001428 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1429 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1430 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1431 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1432 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001433 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1434 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1435 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1436 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1437 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1438 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1439 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001442 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1443 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1444 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1445 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001447pp2-never-send-local
1448 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1449 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1450 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1451 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1452 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1453 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1454 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1455 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1456 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1457 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1458 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1459
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001460presetenv <name> <value>
1461 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1462 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1463 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1464 and "unsetenv".
1465
1466resetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1468 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1469 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1470 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1471 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1472 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1473 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1475
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001476stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001477 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1478 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1479 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1480 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1481 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1482 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001483 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001484 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1485 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1486 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1487 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001488
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001489server-state-base <directory>
1490 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001491 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1492 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001493
1494server-state-file <file>
1495 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1496 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1497 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1498 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1499 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1500 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1501 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1502 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001503 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1504 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001505
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001506setenv <name> <value>
1507 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1508 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1509 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1510 and "unsetenv".
1511
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001512set-dumpable
1513 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001514 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1515 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1516 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1517 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1518 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1519 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1520 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1521 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1522 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1523 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1524 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1525 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1526 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1527 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1528 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1529 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1530 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001531
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001532ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1534 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001535 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001536 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001537 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1538 information and recommendations see e.g.
1539 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1540 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1541 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1542 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001543
1544ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1547 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1548 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1549 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001550 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1551 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1552 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001553 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001554
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001555ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1558 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1559 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1560 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1561
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001562ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1564 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1565 keyword to see available options.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001569 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001570
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001571ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1573 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001574 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001575 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1577 information and recommendations see e.g.
1578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1580 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1581 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1582 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001583
1584ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1586 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1587 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1588 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1589 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001590 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1591 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1592 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1593 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001595ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1598 keyword to see available options.
1599
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1602 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1603 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001606 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1607 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1608 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1609 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001610 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1611 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1612 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1613
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001614ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1615 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1616 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001617 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001618 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001619 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1620
1621 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001622
1623 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1624 and won't try to remove them.
1625
1626 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1627
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001628ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001629 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001630 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1631 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001632
1633 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1634 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1635 optimize the startup time.
1636
1637 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1638 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1639 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1640
1641 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001642 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001643
1644 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001645 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1646
1647 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1648 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1649 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1650 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1651 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1652 bind configuration..
1653
1654 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1655 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1656 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1657 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1658 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1659 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1660 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1661 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1662
1663 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1664
1665 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1666 a cert bundle.
1667
1668 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1669 separately in several "crt".
1670
1671 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1672 since files are loading separately.
1673
1674 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1675 required to commit them.
1676
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001677 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001678 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001679
1680 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1681
1682 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1683
1684 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1685 not provided in the PEM file.
1686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001687 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1688 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1689
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001690 The default behavior is "all".
1691
1692 Example:
1693 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1694 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1695 ssl-load-extra-files none
1696
1697 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1698
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001699ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1700 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1702 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1703
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001704ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001705 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001706 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1707 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1708 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1709 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1710 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1711 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001712 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001713
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001714stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1715 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1716 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1717 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001718 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001719 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001721 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1722 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1723 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1726 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1727 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001728 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001729
1730stats maxconn <connections>
1731 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1732 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734uid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001735 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1737 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1738 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1739
1740ulimit-n <number>
1741 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1742 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1743 option.
1744
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001745unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1746 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1747
1748 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1749 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1750 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1751 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1752 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1753 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1754 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1755 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1756 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1757 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759unsetenv [<name> ...]
1760 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1761 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1762 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1763 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1764 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1765 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1766 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768user <user name>
1769 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1770 See also "uid" and "group".
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001772node <name>
1773 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1774
1775 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1776 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1777 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1778 traffic.
1779
1780description <text>
1781 Add a text that describes the instance.
1782
1783 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1784 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1785 "<" and ">" characters.
1786
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178751degrees-data-file <file path>
1788 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001791 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001792 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000179451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1796 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1797 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1798
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001799 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001800 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1801
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200180251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001803 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1804 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1805
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001806 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1807 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1808
180951degrees-cache-size <number>
1810 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1811 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1812 By default, this cache is disabled.
1813
1814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001817wurfl-data-file <file path>
1818 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1819 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1820
1821 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1822 with USE_WURFL=1.
1823
1824wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1825 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1826 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1827 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1828
1829 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1830
1831 Valid WURFL properties are:
1832 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1833
1834 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1835 device.
1836
1837 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1838 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1839
1840 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1841 particular web request.
1842
1843 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1844 used Libwurfl API version.
1845
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001846 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1847 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1848
1849 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1850 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1851
1852 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1853
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001854 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1855 with USE_WURFL=1.
1856
1857wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1858 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1859 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1860
1861 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1862 with USE_WURFL=1.
1863
1864wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1865 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1866 thus before the chroot.
1867
1868 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1869 with USE_WURFL=1.
1870
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001871wurfl-cache-size <size>
1872 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1873 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001874 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001875 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001876
1877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001880strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001881 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1882 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1883 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1884 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1885 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888-----------------------
1889
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001890busy-polling
1891 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1892 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1893 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1894 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1895 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1896 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1897 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1898 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1899 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1900 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1901 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1902 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1903 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1904 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1905 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1906 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1907 "poll" pollers.
1908
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001909 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1910 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1911 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1912
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001913max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1914 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1915 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1916 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1917 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1918 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1919 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1920 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1921 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923maxconn <number>
1924 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1925 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1926 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001927 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1928 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1929 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1930 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001931 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1932 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1933 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1934 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1935 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1936 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001937
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001938maxconnrate <number>
1939 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1940 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1941 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1942 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1943 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1944 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1945 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1946 fairness.
1947
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001948maxcomprate <number>
1949 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001951 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1952 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1953 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001954 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001955 default value.
1956
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001957maxcompcpuusage <number>
1958 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1959 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1960 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1961 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1962 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1963 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1964 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1965 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1966
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001967maxpipes <number>
1968 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1969 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1970 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1971 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1972 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1973 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1974
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001975maxsessrate <number>
1976 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1977 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1978 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1979 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1980 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1981 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1982 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1983 fairness.
1984
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001985maxsslconn <number>
1986 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1987 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1988 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1989 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1990 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1991 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1992 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001993 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1994 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1995 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1996 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1997 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1998 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1999 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002000
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002001maxsslrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2003 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2004 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2005 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2006 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2007 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2008 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2009 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2010 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2011 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2012
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002013maxzlibmem <number>
2014 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2015 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2016 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002017 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2018 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2019 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021noepoll
2022 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026nokqueue
2027 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2028 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2029 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2030
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002031noevports
2032 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2033 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2034 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2035 also "nopoll".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037nopoll
2038 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2039 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002041 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2042 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002043
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044nosplice
2045 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002046 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002047 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002049 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2050 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2051 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2052 "option splice-response".
2053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002054nogetaddrinfo
2055 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2056 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2057
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002058noreuseport
2059 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2060 command line argument "-dR".
2061
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002062profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2063 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2064 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2065 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2066 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002067 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002068 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2069 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2070 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2071 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2072
2073 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2074 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2075 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2076 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2077 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002078 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2079 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2080 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2081 CLI.
2082
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002083spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002084 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2085 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2086 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2087 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2088 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2089 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002092 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002094 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2095 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2096 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2097 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2098 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2100 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002101 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2102 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2103 openssl configuration file uses:
2104 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2105
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002106ssl-mode-async
2107 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002108 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002109 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2110 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2111 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002112 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002113 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002114
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002115tune.buffers.limit <number>
2116 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2117 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2118 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2119 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2120 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002122 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2123 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2124 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2125 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2126 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2127 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2128 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2129 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2130 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2131
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002132tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2133 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2134 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2135 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2136 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2137
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002138tune.bufsize <number>
2139 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2140 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2141 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2142 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2143 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2144 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2145 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002146 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2147 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2148 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002149 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002150 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2151 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2152 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002153
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002154tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2155 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002156
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002157tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2158 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2159 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2160 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2161 this value. The default value is 1.
2162
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002163tune.fail-alloc
2164 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2165 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2166 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2167 gracefully.
2168
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002169tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2170 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2171 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2172 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2173 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2174 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2175
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002176tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2177 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2178 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2179 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2180 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2181 change it.
2182
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002183tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2184 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002185 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2186 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002187 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2188 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2189 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2190 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2191 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2192
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002193tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2194 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2195 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2196 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2197 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2198 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2199 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2200 recommended not to change this value.
2201
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002202tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2204 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2205 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2206 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2207 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2208 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2209 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2210
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002211tune.http.cookielen <number>
2212 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2213 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2214 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2215 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2216 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2217 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2218 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2219 to change this value.
2220
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2223 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002224 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002225 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002226 configuration directives too.
2227 The default value is 1024.
2228
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002229tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2230 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2231 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2232 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2233 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2234 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2235 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002236 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2237 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2238 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002239
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002240tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2241 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2242 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2243 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2244 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2245 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2246 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau37e07892021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002247 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2248 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2249 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2250 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2251 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002252
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002253tune.idletimer <timeout>
2254 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2255 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2256 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2257 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2258 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2259 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002260 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002261 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002262 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2263
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002264tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2265 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2266 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2267 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2268 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2269 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2270 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2271 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2272 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2273 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2274
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002275tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2276 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002277 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002278 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2279 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002280 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002281 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2282 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2283
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002284tune.lua.maxmem
2285 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2286 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2287 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2288 memory.
2289
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002290tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2291 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002292 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2293 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002294 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002295
2296tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2297 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2298 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2299 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2300 check servers.
2301
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002302tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2303 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2304 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2305 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002306 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002307
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002308tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002309 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2310 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau8fa7f222021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002311 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2312 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2313 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2314 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2315 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2316 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2317 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2318 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2319 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002320
2321tune.maxpollevents <number>
2322 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2323 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2324 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2325 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2326 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2327
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002328tune.maxrewrite <number>
2329 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2330 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2331 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2332 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2333 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2334 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2335 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2336 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2337 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2338 bufsize.
2339
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002340tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2341 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2342 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2343 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2344 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2345 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2346 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2347 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2348 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2349 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002350 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2351 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002352 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2353 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2354 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2355 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2356 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2357 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2358 setting this parameter to 0.
2359
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002360tune.pipesize <number>
2361 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2362 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2363 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2364 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2365 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2366 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2367
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002368tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2369 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2370 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2371 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2372 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2373 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2374 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002375 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002376
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002377tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2378 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2379 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2380 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2381 default is 20.
2382
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002383tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2384tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2385 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2386 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2387 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002388 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002390 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2391 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2392
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002393tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002394 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002395 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2396 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2397 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2398 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2399
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002400tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002401 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau20076a02021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002402 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2403 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2404 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2405 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2406 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2407 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2408 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002409
2410tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2411 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2412 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2413 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2414 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2415 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2416 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2417 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2418 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2419 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002420
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002421tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2422tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2423 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2424 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2425 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002426 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002427 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002428 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2429 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2430 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2431 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2432 notifying haproxy again.
2433
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002434tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002435 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchydede64a2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002436 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2437 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2438 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2439 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2440 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2441 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2442 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2443 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2444 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2445 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2446 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002447
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002448tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002449 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002450 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2451 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2452 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2453 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2454 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2455
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002456tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2457 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2458 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2459 performances. This is disabled by default.
2460
2461 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2462 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2463
2464 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2465
2466 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2467
2468 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2469
2470 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2471 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2472 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2473
2474 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2475 converted.
2476
2477 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2478 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2479 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2480 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2481 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2482 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2483 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002484 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2485 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002486
2487 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2488
2489 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2490 only need this line:
2491
2492 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2493
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002494tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2495 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002496 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002497 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2498 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2499 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2500 being used for too long.
2501
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002502tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2503 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2504 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2505 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2506 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2507 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2508 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2509 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2510 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2511 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2512 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002513 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002514 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002515
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002516tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2517 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2518 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2519 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2520 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002521 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002522 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2523 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002524 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2525 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002526
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002527tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2528 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2529 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2530 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2531 1000 entries.
2532
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002533tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2534 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2535 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2536 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2537
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002538tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002539tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002540tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2541tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2542tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002543 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2544 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2545 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2546 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2547 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2548 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2549 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2550 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002551
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002552 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2553 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2554 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2555 all available space is consumed.
2556 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2557 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2558 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002559
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002560tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2561 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002562 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002563 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002564 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002565 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2566
2567tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2568 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2569 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2571 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025733.3. Debugging
2574--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002575
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002576quiet
2577 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2578 line argument "-q".
2579
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002580zero-warning
2581 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2582 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2583 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2584 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2585 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2586 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2587
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025893.4. Userlists
2590--------------
2591It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2592http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2593it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2594
2595userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002596 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002597 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2598
2599group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002600 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002601 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2602 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2603
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002604user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2605 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002606 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2607 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002608 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2609 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2610 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2611 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002612
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002613 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2614 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2615 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2616 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2617 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2618 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2619 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2620 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2621 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
2623 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002624 userlist L1
2625 group G1 users tiger,scott
2626 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002627
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002628 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2629 user scott insecure-password elgato
2630 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002631
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002632 userlist L2
2633 group G1
2634 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002635
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002636 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2637 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2638 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002639
2640 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002641
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002642
26433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002644----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002645It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2646several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2647instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2648values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2649automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2650In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2651using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2652tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2653reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2654Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2655that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2656each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002657
2658peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002659 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002660 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2661
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002662bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2663 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2664 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2665
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002666disabled
2667 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2668 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2669 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2670
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002671default-bind [param*]
2672 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2673
2674default-server [param*]
2675 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2676
2677 Arguments:
2678 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2679 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2680 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2681 details.
2682
2683
2684 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2685
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002686enable
2687 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2688
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002689log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002690 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2691 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2692 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2693 more details.
2694
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002695peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002696 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2697 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002698 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2699 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2700 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2701 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2702 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002703
2704 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2705 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2706
2707 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002708 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2709 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2710 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002711
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002712 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2713 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002714
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002715 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2716 "server" keyword explanation below).
2717
2718server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002719 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002720 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2721 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2722 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2723 of this "peers" section).
2724 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2725
2726
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002727 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002728 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002729 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002730 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2731 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2732 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002733
2734 backend mybackend
2735 mode tcp
2736 balance roundrobin
2737 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2738 stick on src
2739
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002740 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2741 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002742
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002743 Example:
2744 peers mypeers
2745 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2746 default-server ssl verify none
2747 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2748 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002749
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002750
2751table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2752 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2753
2754 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2755 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002756 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002757 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2758 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2759 "stick-table" keyword).
2760
2761 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2762 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2763 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2764 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2765 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2766 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2767 of the stick-table name as follows:
2768
2769 peers mypeers
2770 peer A ...
2771 peer B ...
2772 table t1 ...
2773
2774 frontend fe1
2775 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2776
2777 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2778 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2779
2780 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2781 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2782 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2783 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2784 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2785 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2786 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2787
2788 peers mypeers
2789 peer A ...
2790 peer B ...
2791 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2792
2793 backend t1
2794 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2795
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002796 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002797 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2798 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2799
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028003.6. Mailers
2801------------
2802It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2803If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2804in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2805
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002806mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002807 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2808 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2809
2810mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2811 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2812
2813 Example:
2814 mailers mymailers
2815 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2816 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2817
2818 backend mybackend
2819 mode tcp
2820 balance roundrobin
2821
2822 email-alert mailers mymailers
2823 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2824 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2825
2826 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2827 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2828
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002829timeout mail <time>
2830 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2831 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2832 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2833 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2834
2835 Example:
2836 mailers mymailers
2837 timeout mail 20s
2838 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002839
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028403.7. Programs
2841-------------
2842In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2843master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2844managed the same way as the workers.
2845
2846During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2847sequence as a worker:
2848
2849 - the master is re-executed
2850 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2851 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2852 instance of the program
2853
2854During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2855
2856program <name>
2857 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2858 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2859 the management guide).
2860
2861command <command> [arguments*]
2862 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2863 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2864 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2865 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2866
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002867user <user name>
2868 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2869 See also "group".
2870
2871group <group name>
2872 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2873 See also "user".
2874
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002875option start-on-reload
2876no option start-on-reload
2877 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2878 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2879 program section.
2880
2881
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028823.8. HTTP-errors
2883----------------
2884
2885It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2886imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2887several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2888
2889http-errors <name>
2890 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2891 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2892
2893errorfile <code> <file>
2894 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2895
2896 Arguments :
2897 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002898 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2899 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002900
2901 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2902 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2903 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2904 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2905 before any chroot is performed.
2906
2907 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2908
2909 Example:
2910 http-errors website-1
2911 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2912 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2913 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2914
2915 http-errors website-2
2916 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2917 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2918 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2919
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029203.9. Rings
2921----------
2922
2923It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2924servers or traces.
2925
2926ring <ringname>
2927 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2928
2929description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002930 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002931 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2932
2933format <format>
2934 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2935
2936 Arguments:
2937 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2938 one of the following :
2939
2940 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2941 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2942 designed to be used with a local log server.
2943
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002944 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2945 field is stripped. This is the default.
2946 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2947 rfc3164.
2948
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002949 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2950 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2951 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2952 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2953 is the default.
2954
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002955 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002956 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2957
2958 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2959 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2960
2961 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2962 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2963 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2964 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2965 logger consumes.
2966
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002967 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2968 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2970 with a local log server.
2971
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002972 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2973 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2974 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2975 used with a local log server.
2976
2977maxlen <length>
2978 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2979 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2980 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2981
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002982server <name> <address> [param*]
2983 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2984 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2985 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2986 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2987 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2988 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2989 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2990 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2991 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002992 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2993 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002994
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002995size <size>
2996 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2997 set to BUFSIZE.
2998
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002999timeout connect <timeout>
3000 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3001
3002 Arguments :
3003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3005 as explained at the top of this document.
3006
3007timeout server <timeout>
3008 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3009
3010 Arguments :
3011 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3012 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3013 as explained at the top of this document.
3014
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003015 Example:
3016 global
3017 log ring@myring local7
3018
3019 ring myring
3020 description "My local buffer"
3021 format rfc3164
3022 maxlen 1200
3023 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003024 timeout connect 5s
3025 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003026 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003027
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030283.10. Log forwarding
3029-------------------
3030
3031It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3032haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3033
3034log-forward <name>
3035 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3036
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003037backlog <conns>
3038 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3039 on connections accept.
3040
3041bind <addr> [param*]
3042 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003043 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3044 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3045 syslog protocol over TCP.
3046 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003047 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3048
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003049dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003050 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3051 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3052 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3053 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003054 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003055
3056log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003057log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003058 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3059 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3060 documentation.
3061 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3062 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3063 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3064 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3065 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3066
3067 Example:
3068 global
3069 log stderr format iso local7
3070
3071 ring myring
3072 description "My local buffer"
3073 format rfc5424
3074 maxlen 1200
3075 size 32764
3076 timeout connect 5s
3077 timeout server 10s
3078 # syslog tcp server
3079 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3080
3081 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003082 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3083 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003084 # all messages on stderr
3085 log global
3086 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3087 log ring@myring local0
3088 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3089 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3090 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3091 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3092 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003093
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003094maxconn <conns>
3095 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3096 10 is the default.
3097
3098timeout client <timeout>
3099 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031014. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003102----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003104Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003105 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003106 - frontend <name>
3107 - backend <name>
3108 - listen <name>
3109
3110A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3111its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3112section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003114
3115A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3116connections.
3117
3118A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3119to forward incoming connections.
3120
3121A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3122parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3125'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3126case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3127
3128Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3129logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3130proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3131However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3132name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3133
3134Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3135and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003136bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3138modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3139arbitrary criteria.
3140
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003141In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3142a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003143the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003144
3145 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3146 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3147 between responses and new requests.
3148
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003149 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3150 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3151 client-facing connection remains open.
3152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003153 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3154 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003155
3156The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3157frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3158following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003159weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003160
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003161 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003162
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003163 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3164 ----+-----+-----+----
3165 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3166 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003167 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3168 ----+-----+-----+----
3169 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031734.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3174--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003176The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3177limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3178they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3179limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003180marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003181option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003182and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3183with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3184specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003186
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003187 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3188------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3189acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003190backlog X X X -
3191balance X - X X
3192bind - X X -
3193bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194capture cookie - X X -
3195capture request header - X X -
3196capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003197clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3198clitcpka-idle X X X -
3199clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003200compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003201cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003202declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003203default-server X - X X
3204default_backend X X X -
3205description - X X X
3206disabled X X X X
3207dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003208email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003209email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003210email-alert mailers X X X X
3211email-alert myhostname X X X X
3212email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003213enabled X X X X
3214errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003215errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003216errorloc X X X X
3217errorloc302 X X X X
3218-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3219errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003220force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003221filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003222fullconn X - X X
3223grace X X X X
3224hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003225http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003226http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003227http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003228http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003229http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003230http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003231http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003232http-check set-var X - X X
3233http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003234http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003235http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003236http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003237http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003238http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003239id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003240ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003241load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003242log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003243log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003244log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003245log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003246max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003247maxconn X X X -
3248mode X X X X
3249monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003250monitor-uri X X X -
3251option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3252option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3253option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3254option allbackups (*) X - X X
3255option checkcache (*) X - X X
3256option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3257option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003258option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003259option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3260option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003261-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3262option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003263option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3264option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003265option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003266option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003267option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003268option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003269option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003270option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3271option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3272option httpchk X - X X
3273option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003274option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003275option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003276option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003277option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003278option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003279option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3280option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3281option logasap (*) X X X -
3282option mysql-check X - X X
3283option nolinger (*) X X X X
3284option originalto X X X X
3285option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003286option pgsql-check X - X X
3287option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003288option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003289option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003290option smtpchk X - X X
3291option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3292option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3293option splice-request (*) X X X X
3294option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003295option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003296option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3297option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3298-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003299option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003300option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3301option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3302option tcpka X X X X
3303option tcplog X X X X
3304option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003305external-check command X - X X
3306external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3308rate-limit sessions X X X -
3309redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003310-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003311retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003312retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003313server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003314server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003315server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003316source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003317srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3318srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3319srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003320stats admin - X X X
3321stats auth X X X X
3322stats enable X X X X
3323stats hide-version X X X X
3324stats http-request - X X X
3325stats realm X X X X
3326stats refresh X X X X
3327stats scope X X X X
3328stats show-desc X X X X
3329stats show-legends X X X X
3330stats show-node X X X X
3331stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3333stick match - - X X
3334stick on - - X X
3335stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003336stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003337stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003338tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003339tcp-check connect X - X X
3340tcp-check expect X - X X
3341tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003342tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003343tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003344tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003345tcp-check set-var X - X X
3346tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003347tcp-request connection - X X -
3348tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003349tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003350tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003351tcp-response content - - X X
3352tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003353timeout check X - X X
3354timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003355timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003356timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003357timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3358timeout http-request X X X X
3359timeout queue X - X X
3360timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003361timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003362timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003363timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003364transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003365unique-id-format X X X -
3366unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003367use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003368use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003369use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3371 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033744.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3375---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376
3377This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3378
3379
3380acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3381 Declare or complete an access list.
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 no | yes | yes | yes
3384 Example:
3385 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3386 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3387 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003389 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
3391
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003392backlog <conns>
3393 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3395 yes | yes | yes | no
3396 Arguments :
3397 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3398 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003399 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003400
3401 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3402 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3403 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3404 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3405 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3406 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3407 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3408 backlog parameter.
3409
3410 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3411 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3412 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3413
3414 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3415
3416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003418balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3421 yes | no | yes | yes
3422 Arguments :
3423 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3424 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3425 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3426 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3427
3428 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3429 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3430 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3431 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003432 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003433 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003434 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3435 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3436 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3437 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3438 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3439 it, so that you don't worry.
3440
3441 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3442 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3443 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3444 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3445 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3446 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3447 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3448 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003450 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3451 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3452 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3453 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3454 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3455 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3456 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003457 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3458 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3459 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003460
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003461 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003462 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003463 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3464 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003465 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003466 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3467 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3468 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3469 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3470 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003471 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3472 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3473 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3474 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3475 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3476 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003477
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3479 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3480 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3481 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3482 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3483 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3484 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3485 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003486 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003487 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003488 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3489 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3490 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003492 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3493 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3494 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3495 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3496 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3497 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3498 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3499 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3500 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3501 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3502 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3503 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003505 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003506 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3507 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3508 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3509 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3510 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3511 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3512 URIs start with a leading "/".
3513
3514 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3515 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3516 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3517 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3518
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003519 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3520 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3521 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3522 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003525 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3526
3527 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003528 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3529 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003530 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3531 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3532 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3533 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003534 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003535 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3536 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003537
3538 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3539 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3540 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3541 server will receive the request.
3542
3543 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3544 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3545 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3546 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3547 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003548 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3549 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3550 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003551
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003552 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3553 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3554 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3555 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3556 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003558 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003559 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3560 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3561 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3562
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003563 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3564 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3565 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3566
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003567 random
3568 random(<draws>)
3569 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003570 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3571 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3572 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3573 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003574 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3575 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3576 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3577 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3578 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3579 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3580 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3581 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3582 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3583 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3584 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3585 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3586 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3587 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3588 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3589 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3590 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3591 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3592 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3593 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003594
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003595 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003596 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003597 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3598 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3599 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3600 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3601 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3602 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003603 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003604 used instead.
3605
3606 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3607 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3608 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3609 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3610
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003611 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3612 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3613 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3614
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003615 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003617 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003618 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3619 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003620
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003621 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3622 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3623 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003624
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003625 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003626 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003627 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3628 NTLM relies on.
3629
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630 Examples :
3631 balance roundrobin
3632 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003633 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003634 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3635 balance hdr(host)
3636 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003637
3638 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3639 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003641 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003642 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3643 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3644 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003645 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003646
3647 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3648 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3649 defaults to 16 kB.
3650
3651 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3652 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3653
3654 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3655 Round Robin.
3656
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003657 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003658 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3659 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3660 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3661
3662 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3663
3664 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003665 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003666 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3667 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3668 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003670 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003673bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3674bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 no | yes | yes | no
3678 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003679 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3680 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3681 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3682 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003683 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003684 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3685 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3686 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3687 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3688 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3689 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003690 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003691 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3692 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003693 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003694 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3695 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003696 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003697 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3698 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003699 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003700 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3701 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3702 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3703 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3704 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3705 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3706 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003707 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3708 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3709 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003710 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3711 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3712 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3713 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003714 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3715 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3716 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003717
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003718 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3719 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003720 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3721 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3722 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003723 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3724 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3725 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3726 the range.
3727
3728 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3729 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3730 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3731 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3732 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3733 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3734 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003735 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003736 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003738 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003740 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3741 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3742 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3743 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3744 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3745 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3746
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003747 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3748 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3749 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3750 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3753 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3754 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3755 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3756 in a frontend.
3757
3758 Example :
3759 listen http_proxy
3760 bind :80,:443
3761 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003762 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003763
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003764 listen http_https_proxy
3765 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003766 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003767
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003768 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3769 bind ipv6@:80
3770 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3771 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3772
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003773 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003774 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003775
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003776 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3777 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3778 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3779 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3780 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3781
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003782 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003783 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
3785
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003786bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003787 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | yes | yes | yes
3790 Arguments :
3791 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3792 may be used to override a default value.
3793
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003794 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003795 option may be combined with other numbers.
3796
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003797 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003798 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3799 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3800 missing from all processes.
3801
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003802 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003803 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003804 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3805 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3806 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3807 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3808 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003809 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003810
3811 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3812 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3813 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3814 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3815 and 'even' instances.
3816
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003817 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3818 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3819 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3820 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003822 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3823 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3824
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003825 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3826 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3827 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3828
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003829 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3830 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3831
3832 Example :
3833 listen app_ip1
3834 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003835 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003836
3837 listen app_ip2
3838 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003839 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003840
3841 listen management
3842 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003843 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003844
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003845 listen management
3846 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3847 bind-process 1-4
3848
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003849 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003850
3851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852capture cookie <name> len <length>
3853 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 no | yes | yes | no
3856 Arguments :
3857 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3858 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3859 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3860 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003862
3863 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3864 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3865 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3866 right if it exceeds <length>.
3867
3868 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3869 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3870 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3871 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3872
3873 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3874 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3875 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3876
3877 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3878 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3879 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003880 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3881 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3882 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003883
3884 Example:
3885 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3886
3887 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003888 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889
3890
3891capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003892 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3894 no | yes | yes | no
3895 Arguments :
3896 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003897 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003898 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3899 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3900 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3901
3902 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3903 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3904 it exceeds <length>.
3905
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003906 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3908 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003909 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3910 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3911 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3912 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003913 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003914 environments to find where the request came from.
3915
3916 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3917 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3918 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3919 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003921 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3922 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3923 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3924 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3925 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926
3927 Example:
3928 capture request header Host len 15
3929 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003930 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003932 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 about logging.
3934
3935
3936capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003937 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3939 no | yes | yes | no
3940 Arguments :
3941 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003942 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3944 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3945 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3946
3947 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3948 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3949 it exceeds <length>.
3950
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003951 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3953 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3954 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003955 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3956 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3957 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3958 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003960 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3961 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3962 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3963 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3964 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965
3966 Example:
3967 capture response header Content-length len 9
3968 capture response header Location len 15
3969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003970 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003971 about logging.
3972
3973
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003974clitcpka-cnt <count>
3975 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3976 the connection on the client side.
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | yes | yes | no
3979 Arguments :
3980 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3981
3982 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3983 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003984 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3985 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003986
3987 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3988
3989
3990clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3991 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3992 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3993 client side.
3994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3995 yes | yes | yes | no
3996 Arguments :
3997 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3998 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3999 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4000 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4001
4002 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4003 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004004 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4005 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004006
4007 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4008
4009
4010clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4011 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | no
4014 Arguments :
4015 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4016 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4017 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4018 document.
4019
4020 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4021 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004022 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4023 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004024
4025 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4026
4027
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004028compression algo <algorithm> ...
4029compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004030compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004031 Enable HTTP compression.
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004035 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4036 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4037 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4038
4039 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004040 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4041 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4042 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004043
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004044 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004045 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004046
4047 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4048 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4049 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4050 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4051 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004052 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004053
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004054 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4055 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4056 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4057 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4058 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4059 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4060 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004061 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004062
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004063 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004064 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004065 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4066 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4067 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4068 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4069 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004070
4071 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4072 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4073 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4074 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4075 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004076 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4077 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4078 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4079 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4080 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004081 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4082 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004083
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004084 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004085 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4086 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivotto7f314c92021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004087 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004088 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004089 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4090 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4091 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4092 "multipart"
4093 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4094 header
4095 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4096 and later
4097 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4098 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004099 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004100
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004101 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004102
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004103 Examples :
4104 compression algo gzip
4105 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004107
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004108cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004109 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4110 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004111 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4114 yes | no | yes | yes
4115 Arguments :
4116 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4117 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4118 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4119 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4120 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4121 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004122 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4124 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4125
4126 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4127 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4128 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4129 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4130 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4131 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004132 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4133 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004134 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004135 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4136 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137
4138 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004139 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004140
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004141 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004142 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004143 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004144 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004145 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4146 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4147 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4148 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4149 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4150 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4151 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
4153 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4154 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4155 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4156 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4157 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4158 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4159 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4160 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4161 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004162 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004163 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4164 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4165 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004167 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4168 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4169 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004170 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4171 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4172 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4173 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004174 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4175 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4176 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004177
4178 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4179 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4180 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4181 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4182 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4183 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4184 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4185 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4186 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4187
4188 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4189 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4190 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4191 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4192 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4193 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4194 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4195 persistence cookie in the cache.
4196 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4197
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004198 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4199 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4200 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4201 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4202 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004203 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004204 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4205 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4206 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4207 they logout.
4208
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004209 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4210 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4211 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4212 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4213
4214 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4215 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4216 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4217 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4218 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4219 this attribute.
4220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004221 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004222 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004223 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4224 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4225 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4226 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4227 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4228 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004230 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4231 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4232 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4233 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4234 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4235 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4236 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4237 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004238 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004239 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4240 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4241 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4242 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4243 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4244 the site.
4245
4246 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4247 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4248 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4249 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4250 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4251 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4252 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4253 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4254 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4255 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4256 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4257 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4258 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004259 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004260 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4261 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4262
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004263 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4264 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4265 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4266 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4267 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4268 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4269
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004270 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4271 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4272 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4273 repeated.
4274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004275 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4276 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4277 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4278 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004280 Examples :
4281 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4282 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4283 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004284 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004286 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004288
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004289declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4290 Declares a capture slot.
4291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 no | yes | yes | no
4293 Arguments:
4294 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4295
4296 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4297 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4298 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4299 for use in the response.
4300
4301 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004302 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004303 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4304
4305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004306default-server [param*]
4307 Change default options for a server in a backend
4308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 yes | no | yes | yes
4310 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004311 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4312 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4313 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4314 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004315
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004316 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004317 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4318
4319 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322default_backend <backend>
4323 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 yes | yes | yes | no
4326 Arguments :
4327 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4328
4329 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4330 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4331 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4332 will catch all undetermined requests.
4333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334 Example :
4335
4336 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4337 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4338 default_backend dynamic
4339
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004340 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004343description <string>
4344 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 no | yes | yes | yes
4347 Arguments : string
4348
4349 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4350 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4351 it describes.
4352 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4353
4354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004355disabled
4356 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | yes | yes | yes
4359 Arguments : none
4360
4361 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4362 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4363 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4364 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4365 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4366 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4367 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4368
4369 See also : "enabled"
4370
4371
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004372dispatch <address>:<port>
4373 Set a default server address
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004376 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004377
4378 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4379 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4380 during start-up.
4381
4382 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4383 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4384 possible with normal servers.
4385
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004386 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004387 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4388 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4389 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4390 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4391
4392 See also : "server"
4393
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004394
4395dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4396 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 yes | no | yes | yes
4399 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4400
4401 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004402 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004403 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4404 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004405 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004406 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004408enabled
4409 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments : none
4413
4414 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4415 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4416
4417 See also : "disabled"
4418
4419
4420errorfile <code> <file>
4421 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 yes | yes | yes | yes
4424 Arguments :
4425 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004426 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004427 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004428
4429 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004430 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004431 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004432 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4433 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004434
4435 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4436 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4437 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4438
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004439 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4440
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004441 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4442 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4443 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4444 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4445 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4446 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4447 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4448 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4449 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004451 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4452 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4453 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004454 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004455 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4456
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004457 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004459 Example :
4460 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004461 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004462 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4463 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4464
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004465
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004466errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4467 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4468 section.
4469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4470 yes | yes | yes | yes
4471 Arguments :
4472 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4473
4474 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004475 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004476 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004477
4478 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4479 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4480 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4481 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4482 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004483 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004484 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4485
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004486 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4487 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004488
4489 Example :
4490 errorfiles generic
4491 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4492
4493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494errorloc <code> <url>
4495errorloc302 <code> <url>
4496 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | yes | yes | yes
4499 Arguments :
4500 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004501 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004502 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004503
4504 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4505 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4506 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4507 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004508 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004509
4510 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4511 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4512 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4513
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004514 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4517 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4518 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4519 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004520 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004521 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4522 request.
4523
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004524 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004525
4526
4527errorloc303 <code> <url>
4528 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | yes | yes | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004533 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004534 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004535
4536 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4537 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4538 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4539 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004540 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004541
4542 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4543 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4544 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4545
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004546 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004548 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4549 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4550 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4551 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004552 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004553
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004554 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004555
4556
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004557email-alert from <emailaddr>
4558 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004559 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | yes | yes | yes
4562
4563 Arguments :
4564
4565 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4566
4567 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4568 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4569
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004570 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004571 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4572 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004573
4574
4575email-alert level <level>
4576 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4577 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | yes
4580
4581 Arguments :
4582
4583 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4584 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4585 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4586
4587 By default level is alert
4588
4589 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4590 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4591 for the proxy.
4592
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004593 Alerts are sent when :
4594
4595 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4596 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4597 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4598 is notice or lower
4599 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4600 and a health check status update occurs
4601
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004602 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4603 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004604 section 3.6 about mailers.
4605
4606
4607email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4608 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | yes | yes | yes
4611
4612 Arguments :
4613
4614 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4615
4616 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4617 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4618
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004619 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4620 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004621
4622
4623email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4624 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4625 mailers.
4626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4627 yes | yes | yes | yes
4628
4629 Arguments :
4630
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004631 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004632
4633 By default the systems hostname is used.
4634
4635 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4636 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4637 for the proxy.
4638
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004639 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4640 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004641
4642
4643email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004644 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004645 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | yes | yes | yes
4648
4649 Arguments :
4650
4651 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4652
4653 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4654 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4655
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004656 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004657 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4658
4659
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004660force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4661 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004663 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004664
4665 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4666 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4667 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4668 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4669 marked down for maintenance operations.
4670
4671 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4672 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4673 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4674 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4675 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4676 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4677 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4678 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4679 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4680
4681 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4682 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4683 is used.
4684
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004685 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004686 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004687
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004688
4689filter <name> [param*]
4690 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4692 no | yes | yes | yes
4693 Arguments :
4694 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4695 referenced in section 9.
4696
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004697 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004698 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004699 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4700 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004701
4702 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4703 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4704
4705 Example:
4706 listen
4707 bind *:80
4708
4709 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4710 filter compression
4711 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4712
4713 compression algo gzip
4714 compression offload
4715
4716 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4717
4718 See also : section 9.
4719
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004720
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721fullconn <conns>
4722 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | no | yes | yes
4725 Arguments :
4726 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4727 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4728
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004729 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004731 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4733 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4734 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4735 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4736 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004737 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004738
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004739 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4740 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004741 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4742 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4743 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004745 Example :
4746 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4747 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4748 # connections.
4749 backend dynamic
4750 fullconn 10000
4751 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4752 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4753
4754 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4755
4756
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004757grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004758 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004760 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004761 Arguments :
4762 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4763 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4764 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4765
4766 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4767 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004768 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004769 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4770
4771 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4772 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4773 simplify it.
4774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004775
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004776hash-balance-factor <factor>
4777 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | no | no | yes
4780 Arguments :
4781 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4782 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004783 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004784
4785 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4786 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4787 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4788 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4789 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4790 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4791 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4792
4793 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4794 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4795 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4796 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4797 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4798
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004799 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4800 consistent hashing mechanism.
4801
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004802 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4803
4804
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004805hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004806 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | no | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004810 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4811 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004812
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004813 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4814 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4815 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4816 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4817 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4818 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4819 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4820 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4821 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4822 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004823
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4825 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4826 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4827 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4828 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4829 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4830 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4831 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4832 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4833 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4834 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4835 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4836 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004837 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4838 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004839
4840 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004842 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004843 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4844 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4845 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004846 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4847 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4848 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004849
4850 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4851 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004852 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4853 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4854 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4855 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4856
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004857 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4858 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4859 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4860 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4861 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4862 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4863 parameter.
4864
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004865 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4866 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4867 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4868 used on strings.
4869
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004870 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4871
4872 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4873 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4874 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4875 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4876 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4877 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4878 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4879 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4880 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4881 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4882 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4883 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004884
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004885 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4886 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4887 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004888
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004889 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004890
4891
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004892http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4893 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4894 ones).
4895
4896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 no | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4900 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4901 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4902 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4903 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4904 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4905
4906 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4907 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4908 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4909
4910 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4911 below.
4912
4913 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4914 instance.
4915
4916 Example:
4917 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4918 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4919 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4920
4921http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4922
4923 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4924 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4925 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4926 example, or to pass some internal information.
4927 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4928 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4929 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4930
4931http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4932
4933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4934 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4935
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004936http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004937
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004938 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4939 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4940 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4941 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4942 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004943
4944http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4945 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4946
4947 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4948
4949 Example:
4950 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4951
4952 # applied to:
4953 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4954
4955 # outputs:
4956 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4957
4958 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4959
4960http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4961 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4962
4963 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4964
4965 Example:
4966 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4967
4968 # applied to:
4969 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4970
4971 # outputs:
4972 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4973
4974http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4975
4976 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4977 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4978 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4979
4980http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4982
4983 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4984 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4985 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4986 fallback.
4987
4988 Example:
4989 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4990 http-response set-status 431
4991 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4992 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4993
4994http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4995
4996 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4997 inline.
4998
4999 Arguments:
5000 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5001 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5002 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5003 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5004 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5005 (request and response)
5006 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5007 processing
5008 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5009 processing
5010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5011 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5012 and '_'.
5013
5014 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5015 followed by some converters.
5016
5017 Example:
5018 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5019
5020http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5021
5022 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5023 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5024 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5025 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5026 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005027 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005028 processing.
5029
5030 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5031 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005032 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005033 rules evaluation.
5034
5035http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5036
5037 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5038 details about <var-name>.
5039
5040 Example:
5041 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5042
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005043
5044http-check comment <string>
5045 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5046 it fails.
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | no | yes | yes
5049
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005050 Arguments :
5051 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5052 rule fails.
5053
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005054 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5055 user-friendly error reporting.
5056
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005057 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005058 "http-check expect".
5059
5060
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005061http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5062 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005063 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005064 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | no | yes | yes
5067
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005068 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005069 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5070
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005071 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005072 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005073
5074 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5075 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5076 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5077 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5078
5079 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5080
5081 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5082
5083 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5084
5085 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5086
5087 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5088
5089 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5090 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5091 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5092 is used.
5093
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005094 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5095 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5096 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5097 haproxy -vv.
5098
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005099 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5100
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005101 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5102 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5103 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5104 different ports or with different servers.
5105
5106 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5107 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5108 the port with a "http-check connect".
5109
5110 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5111 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5112 do.
5113
5114 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5115 unset-var or comment rules.
5116
5117 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005118 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5119 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5120 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5121 option httpchk
5122
5123 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005124 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005125 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005126 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005127 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005128 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005129
5130 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5131
5132 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005133
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005135http-check disable-on-404
5136 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005138 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005139 Arguments : none
5140
5141 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5142 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5143 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5144 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5145 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5146 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5147 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5148 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005149 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5150 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5151 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5152
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005153 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005154
5155
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005156http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005157 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5158 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5159 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005160 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005162 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005163
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005164 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005165 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5166
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005167 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5168 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5169 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5170 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5171 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5172 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5173 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5174 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5175 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5176 result is always conclusive.
5177
5178 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5179 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5180 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005181 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5182 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5183 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5184 example 404 with disable-on-404
5185 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5186 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5187 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005188
5189 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5190 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005191 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5192 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5193 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5194 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5195 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5196 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005197
5198 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5199 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005200 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5201 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5202 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5203 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005204 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5205
5206 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5207 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5208 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5209 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5210
5211 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5212 informational message reported in logs if an error
5213 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5214 log-format string.
5215
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005216 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005217 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5218 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005219 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5220 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5221 details on the supported keywords.
5222
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005223 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5224 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5225 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5226 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005227
5228 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5229 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5230 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5231 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5232 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5233
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005234 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5235 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5236 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5237 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5238 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5239 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5240 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005241
5242 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005243 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005244 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5245 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5246 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5247 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5248
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005249 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5250 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005251 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5252 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5253 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5254 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5255 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5256 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5257 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5258 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005259 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5260 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5261 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5262 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5263 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5264 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5265 insensitive on the header names.
5266
5267 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5268 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5269 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5270 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5271 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5272 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005273
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005274 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005275 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005276 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5277 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5278 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5279 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5280 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005281 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005282 trace).
5283
5284 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005285 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005286 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5287 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5288 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5289 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5290 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005291 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005292
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005293 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5294 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5295 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5296 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5297 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5298 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5299
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005300 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005301 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005302 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5303 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5304 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5305 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5306 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5307 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5308
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005309 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5310 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5311 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5312 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5313 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005314
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005315 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5316 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5317
5318 Examples :
5319 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005320 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005321
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005322 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5323 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5324
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005325 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005326 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005327
5328 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005329 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005330
5331 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005332 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005333
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005334 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005335 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336
5337
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005338http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005339 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5340 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005341 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5342 health checks.
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 yes | no | yes | yes
5345 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005346 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5347
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005348 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5349 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5350 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5351 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5352 to invent non-standard ones.
5353
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005354 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5355 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5356 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5357 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5358
5359 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5360 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5361 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5362 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005363
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005364 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005365 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005366 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005367 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5368 to add it.
5369
5370 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5371 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5372 to the log-format rules.
5373
5374 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5375 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5376 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005377
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005378 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5379 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5380 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5381 request.
5382
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005383 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5384 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5385 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005386 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5387 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5388 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5389 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005390 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005391
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005393 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5394 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005395
5396 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5397 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5398 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5399 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5400 configured request authority.
5401
5402 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5403 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005406
5407
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005408http-check send-state
5409 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5411 yes | no | yes | yes
5412 Arguments : none
5413
5414 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5415 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5416 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5417 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5418 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5419
5420 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5421 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5422 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5423 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5424 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005425 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5426 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5427 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5428
5429 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5430 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5431 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5432
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005433 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5434 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5435 checked in multiple backends.
5436
5437 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5438 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5439
5440 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5441 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5442 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5443 one fails.
5444
5445 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5446 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5447 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5448
5449 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5450 server's queue.
5451
5452 Example of a header received by the application server :
5453 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5454 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005456 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5457 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459
5460http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | no | yes | yes
5464
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005465 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5467 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5468 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5469 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5470 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5471 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5472 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5473 and '-'.
5474
5475 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5476
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005477 Examples :
5478 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005479
5480
5481http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005482 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | no | yes | yes
5485
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005486 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5488 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5491 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5492 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5493 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5494 and '-'.
5495
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005496 Examples :
5497 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005499
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005500http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5501 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5502 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5503 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5504 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | yes | yes | yes
5507 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005508 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005509 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005510 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5511 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005512
5513 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5514 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5515 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5516 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5517
5518 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5519 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5520 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5521 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5522
5523 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5524 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5525 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5526 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5527 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5528 chroot is performed.
5529
5530 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5531 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5532 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5533 considered.
5534
5535 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5536 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5537 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5538 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5539 considered as a raw string.
5540
5541 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5542 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5543 "content-type".
5544
5545 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5546 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5547 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5548 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5549 evaluated as a log-format string.
5550
5551 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5552 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5553 argument to "content-type".
5554
5555 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5556 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5557 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5558 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5559
5560 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5561 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5562 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5563 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5564 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5565 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5566 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5567 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5568
5569 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5570 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5571 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5572
5573 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5574 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5575
5576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005577http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005578 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5579
5580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5581 no | yes | yes | yes
5582
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005583 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5584 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5585 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5586 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5587 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005589 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5590 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005594 Example:
5595 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5596 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5597 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005599 http-request allow if nagios
5600 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5601 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5602 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005604 Example:
5605 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5606 acl add path /addacl
5607 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005609 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5612 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614 Example:
5615 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5616 acl setmap path /setmap
5617 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005619 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005621 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5622 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005624 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5625 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5630 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5631 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5632 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5633 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5634 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5635 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5636 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5641 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5642 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5643 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5644 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5645 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5646 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5647 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005651 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5652 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005653
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005655http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005657 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5658 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5659 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5660 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5661 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005662
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005663 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5664 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5665 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5666 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5667 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5668 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5669 instead.
5670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671 Example:
5672 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5673 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005674
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005675http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005676
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005677 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005679http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5680 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005682 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5683 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5684 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5685 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5686 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5687 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5688 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5689 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5690 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5693 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5694 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005695 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5696
5697 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5698 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5699 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5700 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005702http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005704 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5705 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5706 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5707 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5708 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5709 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005710
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005711http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005712
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005713 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5714 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5715 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5716 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5717 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005719http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005721 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5722 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5723 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5724 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5725 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5726 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005727
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005728http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5729http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5730 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5731 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5732 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5733 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005734
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005735 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5736 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5737 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005738 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005739 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5740 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5741 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005742 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005743 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005744
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005745http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5746 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5747 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5748 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5749
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005750http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5751
5752 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5753 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5754 pointed by <resolvers>.
5755 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5756 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5757 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5758 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5759 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5760 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5761 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5762 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5763 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5764 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5765 to 0.0.0.0.
5766
5767 Example:
5768 resolvers mydns
5769 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5770 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5771 timeout retry 1s
5772 hold valid 10s
5773 hold nx 3s
5774 hold other 3s
5775 hold obsolete 0s
5776 accepted_payload_size 8192
5777
5778 frontend fe
5779 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5780 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5781 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5782
5783 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5784 # which mean DNS resolution error
5785 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5786
5787 default_backend be
5788
5789 backend b_503
5790 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5791 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5792 # 503 error page to end users
5793
5794 backend be
5795 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5796 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5797 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5798 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5799 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5800
5801 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5802 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5803
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005804http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5805
5806 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5807 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5808 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5809 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005810 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5811 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005812
5813 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5818 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5819 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5820 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5821 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005825 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5826 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5827 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5828 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5831 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005832
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005833 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005834 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5835 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5836 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5837 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5838 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005839
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005840 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5841 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5842 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5843 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5844 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005845
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005846 Example:
5847 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5848
5849 # applied to:
5850 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5851
5852 # outputs:
5853 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5854
5855 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005856
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005857 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5858
5859 # applied to:
5860 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005861
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005862 # outputs:
5863 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005864
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005865http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5866 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5867
5868 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5869 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005870 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5871 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5872 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005873
5874 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5875 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5876 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5877
5878 Example:
5879 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5880 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5881
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005882 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5883 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5884 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5885 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5886
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005887http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889
5890 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5891 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5892 query-string are replaced.
5893
5894 Example:
5895 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5896 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5897
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005898http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5900
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005901 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5902 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5903 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5904 against.
5905
5906 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5907 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5908 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005909
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005910 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5911 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5912 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5913 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5914 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5915 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5916 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5917 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5918 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005919 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5920 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005921
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005922 Example:
5923 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5924 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005925
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005926 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5927 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005929http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005931
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005932 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5933 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5934 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5935 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005936
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005937 Example:
5938 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005939
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005940 # applied to:
5941 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005942
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005943 # outputs:
5944 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005945
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005946http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5947 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5948 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005949 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5951
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005952 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005953 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5954 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005955 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005956 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005957 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005958 are followed to create the response :
5959
5960 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5961 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5962 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5963 ignored.
5964
5965 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5966 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005967 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005968 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5969 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005970
5971 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5972 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5973 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005974 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005975 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005976
5977 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5978 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5979 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005980 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005981 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5982 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005983
5984 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5985 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5986 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5987 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5988 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5989 as a raw content.
5990
5991 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5992 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5993 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5994 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5995 considered as a raw string.
5996
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005997 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005998 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5999 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6000 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6001
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006002 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6003 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006004 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006005
6006 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6007
6008 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006009 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006010 if { path /ping }
6011
6012 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6013 if { path /favicon.ico }
6014
6015 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6016 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6017 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6020http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6023 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6024 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006025
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006026http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6027 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006028
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006029 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6030 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6031 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6032 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006036 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6037 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6038 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6039 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6040 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 Arguments:
6043 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6044 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 Example:
6047 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6048 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6051 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6056 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6057 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059 Arguments:
6060 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6061 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063 Example:
6064 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6065 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6068 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6069 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6074 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6075 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6076 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6077 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079 Example:
6080 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6081 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6083 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6084 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6085 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6086 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6087 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6088 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6093 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6094 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6095 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6096 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6102 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6103 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6104 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6105 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6106 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6107 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6108 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6109 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6114 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6115 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6116 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6117 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6118 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6119 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6124 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6125 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006127http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6130 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6131 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6132 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6133 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6134 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6135 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6136 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006138http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006140 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6141 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6142 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6143 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6144 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6145 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 Example :
6148 # prepend the host name before the path
6149 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006150
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006151http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6152
6153 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6154 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6155 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006157http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006159 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6160 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6161 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6162 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6163 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006165http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006167 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6168 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6169 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6170 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6171 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6172 values have higher priority.
6173 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6174 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6175 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6176 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6177 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6182 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6183 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6184 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6185 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6186 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6187 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006190
6191 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6193 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006195http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6196 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6197 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6198 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006199 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6200 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006201
6202 Arguments :
6203 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6204 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006205
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006206 See also "option forwardfor".
6207
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006208 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006209 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6210 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6211
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006212 # After the masking this will track connections
6213 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6214 http-request track-sc0 src
6215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006216 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6217 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6218
6219http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6220
6221 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6222 expression.
6223
6224 Arguments:
6225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6226 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006227
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006228 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006229 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6230 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6231
6232 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6233 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6234 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6235
6236http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6237
6238 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6239 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6240 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6241 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6242 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6243 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6244 information from the request.
6245
6246 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6247
6248http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6249
6250 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6251 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6252 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6253 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6254 path and the query string.
6255 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6256
6257http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6258
6259 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6260 inline.
6261
6262 Arguments:
6263 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6264 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6268 (request and response)
6269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6270 processing
6271 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6272 processing
6273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6274 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6275 and '_'.
6276
6277 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6278 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006279
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006280 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006281 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006283http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6284 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6287 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6288 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6289 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6290 agent name must be used.
6291
6292 Arguments:
6293 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6294
6295 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6296 configuration.
6297
6298http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6299
6300 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6301 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6302 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6303 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6304 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6305 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6306 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6307 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6308 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6309 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6310 action.
6311 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6312 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6313 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6314 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6315 you fully understand how it works.
6316
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006317http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6318
6319 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6320 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6321 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6322 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6323 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006324 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006325 processing.
6326
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006327 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006328 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6329 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6330 rules evaluation.
6331
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006332http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6333http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6334 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6335 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6336 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6337 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338
6339 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6340 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6341 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006342 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6343 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6344 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6345 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6346 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6347 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6348 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6349 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6350 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6351 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006352 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006353 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6354 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6355 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6356 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6357 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358
6359http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6361http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6362
6363 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6364 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6365 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6366 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006367 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6369 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6370 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6371 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6372 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6373 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6374 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6375
6376 Arguments :
6377 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6378 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6379 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6380 select which table entry to update the counters.
6381
6382 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6383 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6384 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6385 that table until the session ends.
6386
6387 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6388 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6389 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6390 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6391 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6392 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6393 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6394 useful information.
6395
6396 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6397 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6398 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6399 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6400 checks that make use of it.
6401
6402http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6403
6404 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006405
6406 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006407 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006408
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006409http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6410
6411 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6412 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6413 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6414 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6415 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6416 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6417
6418 Arguments :
6419 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6420
6421 Example:
6422 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006424http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6427 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6428 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006429
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006431http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006432 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6433
6434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6435 no | yes | yes | yes
6436
6437 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6438 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6439 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6440 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6441 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6442 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6445 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006447 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 Example:
6450 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006452 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006453
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006454 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6455 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006457 Example:
6458 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006460 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006461
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006462 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6463 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006465 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6466 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006468http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006470 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6471 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6472 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6473 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6474 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6475 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6476 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6477 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006479http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006481 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6482 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6483 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6484 example, or to pass some internal information.
6485 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6486 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6487 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006489http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006491 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6492 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006493
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006494http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006495
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006496 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006498http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6501 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6502 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6503 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6504 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6505 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6506 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006508 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6509 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6510 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6511 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6512 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006513
6514 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6515 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6516 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6517 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006518
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006519http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006521 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6522 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6523 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6524 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6525 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6526 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006527
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006528http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006529
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006530 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6531 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6532 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6533 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6534 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006536http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006537
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006538 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6539 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6540 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6541 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6542 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6543 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006544
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006545http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6546http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6547 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6548 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6549 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6550 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006551
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006552 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6553 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6554 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006555 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006556 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6557 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6558 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006559 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006560 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006562http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006563
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006564 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6565 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6566 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6567 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6568 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6569 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006570
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006571http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006573
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006574 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6575 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006577 Example:
6578 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006579
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006580 # applied to:
6581 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006583 # outputs:
6584 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006588http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006590
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006591 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006592 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006593
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006594 Example:
6595 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006596
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006597 # applied to:
6598 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006599
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006600 # outputs:
6601 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006603http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6604 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6605 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006606 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6608
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006609 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006610 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6611 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006612 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006613 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006614 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006615 are followed to create the response :
6616
6617 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6618 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6619 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6620 ignored.
6621
6622 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6623 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006624 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006625 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6626 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006627
6628 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6629 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6630 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006631 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006632 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006633
6634 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6635 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6636 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006637 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006638 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6639 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006640
6641 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6642 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6643 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6644 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6645 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6646 as a raw content.
6647
6648 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6649 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6650 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6651 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6652 considered as a raw string.
6653
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006654 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6655 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6656 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6657 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6658
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006659 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6660 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006661 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006662
6663 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6664
6665 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006666 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006667 if { status eq 404 }
6668
6669 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6670 string "This is the end !" \
6671 if { status eq 500 }
6672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006673http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6674http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006676 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6677 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6678 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006679
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006680http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6681 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006682
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006683 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6684 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6685 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6686 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006688http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006690 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6691 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6692 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6693 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6694 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006696 Arguments:
6697 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006699 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6700 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006702http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006703
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006704 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6705 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6706 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006708http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6709
6710 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6711 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6712 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6713 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6714 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6715
6716http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6717
6718 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6719 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6720 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6721 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6722 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6723 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6724 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6725 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6726 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6727
6728http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6729
6730 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6731 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6732 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6733 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6734 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6735 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6736 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6737
6738http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6739
6740 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6741 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6742 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6743 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6744 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6745 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6746 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6747 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6748
6749http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6750 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6751
6752 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6753 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6754 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6755 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006756
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006757 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006758 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6759 http-response set-status 431
6760 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6761 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006763http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006765 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6766 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6767 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6768 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6769 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6770 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6771 based on some information from the request.
6772
6773 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6774
6775http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6776
6777 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6778 inline.
6779
6780 Arguments:
6781 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6782 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6783 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6784 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6785 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6786 (request and response)
6787 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6788 processing
6789 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6790 processing
6791 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6792 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6793 and '_'.
6794
6795 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6796 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006797
6798 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006799 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006801http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006803 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6804 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6805 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6806 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6807 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6808 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6809 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6810 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6811 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6812 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6813 action.
6814 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6815 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6816 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6817 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6818 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006819
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006820http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6821
6822 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6823 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6824 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6825 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6826 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006827 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006828 processing.
6829
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006830 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006831 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006832 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006833 rules evaluation.
6834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006835http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6836http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6837http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006839 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6840 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6841 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6842 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6843 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6844 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6845
6846http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6847
6848 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6849 about <var-name>.
6850
6851 Example:
6852 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6853
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006854
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006855http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6856 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6857
6858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6859 yes | no | yes | yes
6860
6861 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006862 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6863 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6864 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006865
6866 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6867
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006868 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6869 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6870 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6871 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6872 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6873 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6874 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6875 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6876 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6877 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006878
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006879 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6880 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6881 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6882 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6883 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6884 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6885 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006886 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6887 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6888 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6889 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6890 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6891 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006892
6893 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6894 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6895 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6896 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6897 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6898 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6899 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6900 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006901 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006902 downsides of rare connection failures.
6903
6904 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6905 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6906 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6907 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6908 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6909 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006910 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006911 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6912 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6913 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6914 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6915 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6916
6917 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006918 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6919 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6920 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006921
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006922 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6923 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6924 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006925
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006926 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6927 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006928
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006929 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006930
6931 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6932 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6933 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6934
6935 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6936
6937
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006938http-send-name-header [<header>]
6939 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006942 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006943 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6944
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006945 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6946 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6947 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6948 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6949 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6950 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6951 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6952 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6953 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6954 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6955 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6956 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6957 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6958 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6959 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6960 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006961
6962 See also : "server"
6963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006964id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006965 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 no | yes | yes | yes
6968 Arguments : none
6969
6970 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6971 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6972 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006973
6974
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006975ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6976 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006978 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006979
6980 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6981 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6982 and running).
6983
6984 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6985 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6986 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006987 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006988 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6989
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006990 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6991 "unless" condition is met.
6992
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006993 Example:
6994 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6995 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6996 ignore-persist if url_static
6997
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006998 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6999
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007000load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7001 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7003 yes | no | yes | yes
7004
7005 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7006 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7007 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007008 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007009 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7010 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7011 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7012 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7013
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007014 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007015 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007016 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007017
7018 Arguments:
7019 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7020 named "server-state-file".
7021
7022 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7023 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7024 name is used as a file name.
7025
7026 none don't load any stat for this backend
7027
7028 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007029 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7030 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7031 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007032 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007033 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007034
7035 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7036 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7037
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007038 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007039
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007040 global
7041 stats socket /tmp/socket
7042 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007043
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007044 defaults
7045 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007046
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007047 backend bk
7048 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7049 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007050
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007051
7052 Then one can run :
7053
7054 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7055
7056 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7057
7058 1
7059 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7060 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7061 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7062
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007063 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007064
7065 global
7066 stats socket /tmp/socket
7067 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7068
7069 defaults
7070 load-server-state-from-file local
7071
7072 backend bk
7073 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7074 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7075
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007076
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007077 Then one can run :
7078
7079 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7080
7081 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7082
7083 1
7084 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7085 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7086 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7087
7088 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7089 "show servers state"
7090
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007092log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007093log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007094 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007095no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007096 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007099
7100 Prefix :
7101 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7102 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7103 prefix does not allow arguments.
7104
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007105 Arguments :
7106 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7107 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7108 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7109 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7110 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7111 parameter.
7112
7113 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7114 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7115
7116 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7117 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7118 standard syslog port).
7119
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007120 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7121 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7122 standard syslog port).
7123
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007124 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7125 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7126 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007127 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007128
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007129 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7130 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7131 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7132 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7133 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7134 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7135 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7136 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7137 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7138 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7139 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7140 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7141 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7142 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7143 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7144 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007145 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7146 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007147
7148 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7149 and "fd@2", see above.
7150
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007151 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7152 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7153 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7154 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7155 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7156 having the logs instantly available.
7157
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007158 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7159 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007160
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007161 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7162 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7163 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7164 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7165 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7166 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7167 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7168 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7169 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7170 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007171 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007172
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007173 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7174 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7175 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7176 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7177 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7178
7179 <sample_size>
7180 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7181 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7182 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7183 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7184 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7185
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007186 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7187 one of the following :
7188
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007189 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7190 field is stripped. This is the default.
7191 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7192 rfc3164.
7193
7194 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007195 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7196
7197 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7198 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7199
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007200 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7201 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7202 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7203 designed to be used with a local log server.
7204
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007205 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7206 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7207 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7208 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7209 systemd logger consumes.
7210
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007211 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7212 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7213 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7214 used with a local log server.
7215
7216 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7217 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7218 designed to be used with a local log server.
7219
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007220 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7221 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7222 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7223 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007225 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7226
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007227 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7228 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7229 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7230
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007231 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7232 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7233 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7234 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007235
7236 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7237 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7238 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007239 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7240 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7241 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7242 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7243 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007244
7245 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7246
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007247 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7248 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7249 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007250
7251 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7252 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7253 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7254 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7255
7256 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7257 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007258
7259 Example :
7260 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007261 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7262 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7263 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007264 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7265 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007266 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007268
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007269log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007270 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7272 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007273
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007274 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7275 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7276 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7277 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7278 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007279
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007280 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7281 "option httplog" directives.
7282
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007283log-format-sd <string>
7284 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7286 yes | yes | yes | no
7287
7288 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7289 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7290 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7291 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7292 which covers the log format string in depth.
7293
7294 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7295 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7296
7297 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7298 log format to "rfc5424".
7299
7300 Example :
7301 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7302
7303
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007304log-tag <string>
7305 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7307 yes | yes | yes | yes
7308
7309 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7310 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7311 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7312 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7313 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7314 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7315 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7316 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7317 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007318
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007319max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7320 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7322 yes | no | yes | yes
7323
7324 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7325 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7326 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7327 servers.
7328
7329 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7330 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7331 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7332 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7333 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007334 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007335 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7336 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7337 picking a different server.
7338
7339 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7340 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7341 even if they have to be queued.
7342
7343 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7344 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7345
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007346max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7347 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7348 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7349 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007350
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007351maxconn <conns>
7352 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7354 yes | yes | yes | no
7355 Arguments :
7356 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7357 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7358 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7359 closes.
7360
7361 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7362 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7363 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7364 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007365 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7366 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7367 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7368 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007369
7370 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7371 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7372 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7373
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007374 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7375 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007377 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7378
7379
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007380mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007381 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 yes | yes | yes | yes
7384 Arguments :
7385 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7386 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7387 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7388 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7389
7390 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7391 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7392 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7393 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7394 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7395
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007396 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7397 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7398 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007399
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007400 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007401 defaults http_instances
7402 mode http
7403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007405monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007406 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007409 Arguments :
7410 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7411 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007412 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007413 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7414 backend and its backup.
7415
7416 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7417 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7418 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7419 servers in a list of backends.
7420
7421 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7422 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7423 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7424 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7425 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7426 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7427 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007428 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7429 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007430
7431 Example:
7432 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007433 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007434 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7435 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7436 monitor-uri /site_alive
7437 monitor fail if site_dead
7438
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007439 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007440
7441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007442monitor-uri <uri>
7443 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7445 yes | yes | yes | no
7446 Arguments :
7447 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7448 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7449
7450 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7451 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7452 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7453 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7454 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7455 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7456 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7457 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7458
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007459 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007460 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7461 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7462 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7463 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7464 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7465 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007466
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007467 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7468 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7469 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7470 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7471
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007472 Example :
7473 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7474 frontend www
7475 mode http
7476 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7477
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007478 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007480
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007481option abortonclose
7482no option abortonclose
7483 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 yes | no | yes | yes
7486 Arguments : none
7487
7488 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7489 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7490 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7491 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007492 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007493 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7494 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7495 encountered while delivering the response.
7496
7497 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7498 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7499 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7500 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7501 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7502 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007503 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007504 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007505 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007506 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7507 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7508 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7511 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007512 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7513 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7514 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7515 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7516 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7517 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007518 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007519
7520 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7521 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7522
7523 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7524
7525
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007526option accept-invalid-http-request
7527no option accept-invalid-http-request
7528 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7530 yes | yes | yes | no
7531 Arguments : none
7532
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007533 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007534 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007535 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007536 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7537 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7538 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7539 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7540 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007541 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7542 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7543 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7544 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007545 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007546 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007547 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7548 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7549 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007550
7551 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7552 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7553 been confirmed.
7554
7555 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7556 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007557 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7558 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007559 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7560
7561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7563
7564 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7565 stats socket.
7566
7567
7568option accept-invalid-http-response
7569no option accept-invalid-http-response
7570 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7572 yes | no | yes | yes
7573 Arguments : none
7574
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007575 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007576 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007577 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007578 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7579 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7580 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7581 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7582 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007583 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7584 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7585 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007586
7587 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7588 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7589 been confirmed.
7590
7591 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7592 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7593 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7594 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7595
7596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7598
7599 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7600 stats socket.
7601
7602
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007603option allbackups
7604no option allbackups
7605 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 yes | no | yes | yes
7608 Arguments : none
7609
7610 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7611 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7612 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7613 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7614 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7615 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7616 order between the backup servers anymore.
7617
7618 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7619 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7620
7621 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7622 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7623
7624
7625option checkcache
7626no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007627 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7629 yes | no | yes | yes
7630 Arguments : none
7631
7632 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7633 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007634 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007635 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7636 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007637 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007638
7639 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007640 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007641 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007642 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7643 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007644 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007645 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007646 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7647 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007648 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007649 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7650 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007651 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007652 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7653 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7654 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7655 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7656 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7657 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7658 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7659 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7660 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7661
7662 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007663 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7664 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7665 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7666 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007667
7668 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7669 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007670 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007672
7673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7675
7676
7677option clitcpka
7678no option clitcpka
7679 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7681 yes | yes | yes | no
7682 Arguments : none
7683
7684 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7685 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007686 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007687 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7688
7689 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7690 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7691 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7692 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7693
7694 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7695 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7696 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7697 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7698 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7699
7700 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7701
7702 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7703 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7704 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7705
7706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7708
7709 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7710
7711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007712option contstats
7713 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7715 yes | yes | yes | no
7716 Arguments : none
7717
7718 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7719 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7720 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7721 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007722 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7723 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7724 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7725 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7726 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007727
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007728option disable-h2-upgrade
7729no option disable-h2-upgrade
7730 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7731 connection.
7732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7733 yes | yes | yes | no
7734 Arguments : none
7735
7736 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7737 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7738 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7739 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7740 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7741 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7742 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7743 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7744
7745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007747
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007748option dontlog-normal
7749no option dontlog-normal
7750 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7752 yes | yes | yes | no
7753 Arguments : none
7754
7755 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7756 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7757 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7758 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7759 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7760 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7761 logged.
7762
7763 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7764 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7765 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007767 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007768 logging.
7769
7770
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007771option dontlognull
7772no option dontlognull
7773 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 yes | yes | yes | no
7776 Arguments : none
7777
7778 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7779 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7780 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7781 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7782 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7783 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007784 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7785 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7786 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007787
7788 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007789 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007790 would not be logged.
7791
7792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7794
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007795 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007796 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007797
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007798
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007799option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007800 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7802 yes | yes | yes | yes
7803 Arguments :
7804 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7805 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007806 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007807 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808
7809 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7810 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7811 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7812 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7813 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7814 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7815 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007816 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7817 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7818 possible that the client has already brought one.
7819
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007820 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007821 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007822 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007823 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007824 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007825 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007826
7827 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7828 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7829 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7830 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7831 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7832 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7833 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7834
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007835 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7836 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7837 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7838 are under the control of the end-user.
7839
Christopher Fauleteac279f2021-04-06 09:01:09 +02007840 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
7841 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
7842
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007843 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007844 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7845 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007846 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7847 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7848 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007849
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007850 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007851 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7852 frontend www
7853 mode http
7854 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7855
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007856 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7857 backend www
7858 mode http
7859 option forwardfor header X-Client
7860
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007861 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007862 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007863
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007864
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007865option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7866no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7867 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7869 yes | yes | yes | no
7870 Arguments : none
7871
7872 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7873 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7874 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7875 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7876 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7877 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7878 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7879
7880 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7881 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7882 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7883 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7884 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7885 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7886 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7887 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7888 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7889 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7890
7891 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7892
7893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7895
7896 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7897 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7898
7899
7900option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7901no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7902 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 yes | no | yes | yes
7905 Arguments : none
7906
7907 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7908 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7909 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7910 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7911 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7912 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7913 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7914
7915 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7916 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7917 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7918 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7919 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7920 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7921 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7922 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7923 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7924 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7925
7926 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7927
7928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7930
7931 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7932 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7933
7934
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007935option http-buffer-request
7936no option http-buffer-request
7937 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | yes | yes | yes
7940 Arguments : none
7941
7942 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7943 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7944 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7945 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7946 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7947 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007948 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7949 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7950 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7951 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007952
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007953 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007954
7955
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007956option http-ignore-probes
7957no option http-ignore-probes
7958 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7960 yes | yes | yes | no
7961 Arguments : none
7962
7963 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7964 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7965 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7966 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7967 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7968 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7969 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7970 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7971 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007972 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7973 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007974 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7975
7976 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7977 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7978 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7979 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7980 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7981 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7982 are often the only way to detect them.
7983
7984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7986
7987 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7988
7989
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007990option http-keep-alive
7991no option http-keep-alive
7992 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7994 yes | yes | yes | yes
7995 Arguments : none
7996
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007997 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7998 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007999 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8000 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008001 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8002 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8003 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008004
8005 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8006 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008007 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8008 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8009 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8010 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8011 situations where this option may be useful :
8012
8013 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008014 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008015
8016 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8017 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8018
8019 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8020 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8021 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8022 request.
8023
8024 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8025 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008026 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8027 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8028 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008029
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008030 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8031 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8032 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8033 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8034 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8035 not set.
8036
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008037 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8038 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8039 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008040
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008041 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008042 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008043 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008044
8045
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008046option http-no-delay
8047no option http-no-delay
8048 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | yes | yes | yes
8051 Arguments : none
8052
8053 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8054 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8055 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8056 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8057 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8058 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8059 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8060 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8061 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8062 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8063 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8064 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8065 affected.
8066
8067 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8068 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8069 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8070 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8071 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8072 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8073 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8074 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8075 latency environments.
8076
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008077 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8078
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008079
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008080option http-pretend-keepalive
8081no option http-pretend-keepalive
8082 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008084 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008085 Arguments : none
8086
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008087 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008088 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8089 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8090 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8091 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8092 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8093 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8094 consider the response complete.
8095
8096 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8097 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8098 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8099 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008100 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008101 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8102
8103 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8104 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8105 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8106 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8107 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8108 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8109 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8110
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008111 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8112 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8113 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8114 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8115 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8116 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008117
8118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8120
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008121 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008122 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008123
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008124
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008125option http-server-close
8126no option http-server-close
8127 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8129 yes | yes | yes | yes
8130 Arguments : none
8131
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008132 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8133 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8134 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8135 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008136 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8137 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8138 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8139 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8140 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8141 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8142 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8143 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8144 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8145 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8146 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008147
8148 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8149 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8150 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8151 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008152 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8153 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008154
8155 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8156 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008157 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8158 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8159 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008160
8161 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8162 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8163
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008164 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8165 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008166
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008167option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008168no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008169 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8171 yes | yes | yes | no
8172 Arguments : none
8173
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008174 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008175 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8176 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8177 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8178 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8179 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8180 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8181
8182 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8183 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008184 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8185 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8186 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008187
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008188 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8189 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8190 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8191 front of an existing proxy.
8192
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008193 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008195 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008196
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008197option httpchk
8198option httpchk <uri>
8199option httpchk <method> <uri>
8200option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008201 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8203 yes | no | yes | yes
8204 Arguments :
8205 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8206 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8207 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8208 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8209 ones.
8210
8211 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8212 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8213 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8214
8215 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8216 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8217 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008218 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008219
8220 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8221 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8222 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8223 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8224 the lack of any response.
8225
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008226 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8227 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8228 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8229 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8230
8231 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8232 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8233 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008235 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8236 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008237 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008238 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008239 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008240
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008241 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8242 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8243 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8244 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008246 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008247 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8248 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8249 backend https_relay
8250 mode tcp
8251 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8252 http-check send hdr Host www
8253 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008255 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8256 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8257 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008258
8259
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008260option httpclose
8261no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008262 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8264 yes | yes | yes | yes
8265 Arguments : none
8266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008267 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8268 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8269 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8270 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008271 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008272
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008273 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8274 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008275 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008276 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8277 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008278
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008279 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8280 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8281 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008282
8283 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8284 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008285 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8286 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8287 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008288
8289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8291
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008292 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008293
8294
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008295option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008296 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008298 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008299 Arguments :
8300 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8301 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8302 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008303 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008304 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008305
8306 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8307 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8308 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8309 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8310 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8311 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8312 ports.
8313
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008314 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8315 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008316
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008317 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008320
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008321
8322option http_proxy
8323no option http_proxy
8324 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8326 yes | yes | yes | yes
8327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8330 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8331 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8332 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8333 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8334
8335 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8336 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008337 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8338 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008339
8340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8342
8343 Example :
8344 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8345 backend direct_forward
8346 option httpclose
8347 option http_proxy
8348
8349 See also : "option httpclose"
8350
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008351
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008352option independent-streams
8353no option independent-streams
8354 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8356 yes | yes | yes | yes
8357 Arguments : none
8358
8359 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8360 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8361 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8362 receive data or not.
8363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008364 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008365 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8366 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8367 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8368 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8369 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8370 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8371 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8372 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8373 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8374 socket buffers.
8375
8376 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8377 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8378 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8379 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8380 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8381
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008382 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008383
8384
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008385option ldap-check
8386 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8388 yes | no | yes | yes
8389 Arguments : none
8390
8391 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8392 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8393 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8394 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8395
8396 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8397 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8398
8399 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8400 configure it.
8401
8402 Example :
8403 option ldap-check
8404
8405 See also : "option httpchk"
8406
8407
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008408option external-check
8409 Use external processes for server health checks
8410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8411 yes | no | yes | yes
8412
8413 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8414 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8415 command".
8416
8417 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8418
8419 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8420
8421
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008422option log-health-checks
8423no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008424 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8426 yes | no | yes | yes
8427 Arguments : none
8428
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008429 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8430 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8431 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008432
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008433 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8434 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8435 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8436 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8437 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8438
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008440 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008441
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008442 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8443 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8444 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008445
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008446
8447option log-separate-errors
8448no option log-separate-errors
8449 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | yes | yes | no
8452 Arguments : none
8453
8454 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8455 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8456 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8457 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8458 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8459 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8460 provides very important information.
8461
8462 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8463 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8464 error logs.
8465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008466 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008467 logging.
8468
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008469
8470option logasap
8471no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008472 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | yes | yes | no
8475 Arguments : none
8476
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008477 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8478 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8479 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8480 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8481
8482 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8483 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8484 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8485 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8486 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008487 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008488 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8489 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8490 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8491 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008492 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008493
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008494 Examples :
8495 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8496 mode http
8497 option httplog
8498 option logasap
8499 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8500
8501 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8502 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8503 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8504 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008506 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008507 logging.
8508
8509
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008510option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008511 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8513 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008514 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008515 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8516 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008517 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8518 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008519
8520 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8521 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008523 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8524 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8525 in the MySQL table, like this :
8526
8527 USE mysql;
8528 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8529 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8530
8531 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008533 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8534 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8535 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8536 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8537 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8538 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8539 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8540
8541 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8542 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008543
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008544 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008545
8546 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8547 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8548 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8549 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008550 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8551 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008552
8553 See also: "option httpchk"
8554
8555
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008556option nolinger
8557no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008558 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008561 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008564 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8565 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8566 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8567 connections.
8568
8569 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8570 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008571 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8572 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8573 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8574 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8575 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8576 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8577 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8578 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8579 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8580 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8581 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8582 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8583 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008584
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008585 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8586 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8587 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8588 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8589 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008590
8591 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8592 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008593 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8594 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8595 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008596
8597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8599
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008600 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8601 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008602
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008603option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8604 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8606 yes | yes | yes | yes
8607 Arguments :
8608 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8609 matching <network>
8610 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8611 header name.
8612
8613 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8614 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8615 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8616 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8617 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8618 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8619 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8620 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8621 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8622 possible that the client has already brought one.
8623
8624 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8625 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8626 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8627 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8628 header and requires different one.
8629
8630 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8631 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8632 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8633 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8634 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8635 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8636 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8637
Christopher Fauleteac279f2021-04-06 09:01:09 +02008638 Only IPv4 addresses are supported. "http-request add-header" or "http-request
8639 set-header" rules may be used to work around this limitation.
8640
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008641 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8642 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8643 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8644 both are defined.
8645
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008646 Examples :
8647 # Original Destination address
8648 frontend www
8649 mode http
8650 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8651
8652 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8653 backend www
8654 mode http
8655 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8656
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008657 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008658
8659
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008660option persist
8661no option persist
8662 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8664 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008665 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008666
8667 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8668 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8669 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8670 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8671 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8672 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8673 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8674 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8675 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8676 redirected to another valid server.
8677
8678 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8679 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8680
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008681 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008682
8683
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008684option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8685 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 yes | no | yes | yes
8688 Arguments :
8689 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8690 PostgreSQL server.
8691
8692 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8693 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8694 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8695 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8696
8697 See also: "option httpchk"
8698
8699
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008700option prefer-last-server
8701no option prefer-last-server
8702 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | no | yes | yes
8705 Arguments : none
8706
8707 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8708 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8709 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8710 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8711 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8712 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8713 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8714 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8715 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008716 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8717 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008718 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8719 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8720 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008721 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8722 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8723 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008724
8725 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8726 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8727
8728 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8729
8730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008731option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008732option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008733no option redispatch
8734 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008737 Arguments :
8738 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8739 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8740 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008741 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008742 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008743 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008744 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8745 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8746 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008748
8749 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8750 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8751 be able to access the service anymore.
8752
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008753 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8754 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008755
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008756 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8757 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8758 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8759 following order:
8760
8761 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8762
8763 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8764 list, or
8765
8766 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8767
8768 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8769 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8770
8771 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8772 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8773 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8774 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8775
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008776 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008777 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8778 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8782
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008783 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008784
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008785
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008786option redis-check
8787 Use redis health checks for server testing
8788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8789 yes | no | yes | yes
8790 Arguments : none
8791
8792 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8793 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8794 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8795 find the "+PONG" response message.
8796
8797 Example :
8798 option redis-check
8799
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008800 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008801
8802
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008803option smtpchk
8804option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8805 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008808 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008809 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008810 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008811 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8812
8813 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8814 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8815 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8816
8817 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8818 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8819 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8820 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8821 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8822 dead server.
8823
8824 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8825 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008826 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008827 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8828
8829 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8830 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8831 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8832 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008833 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008834
8835 Example :
8836 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8837
8838 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008841option socket-stats
8842no option socket-stats
8843
8844 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8846 yes | yes | yes | no
8847
8848 Arguments : none
8849
8850
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008851option splice-auto
8852no option splice-auto
8853 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 yes | yes | yes | yes
8856 Arguments : none
8857
8858 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8859 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008860 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008861 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008862 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008863 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8864 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8865 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8866 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8867
8868 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8869 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8870 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8871 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8872 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8873 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8874 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8875 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8876 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8877 keyword.
8878
8879 Example :
8880 option splice-auto
8881
8882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8884
8885 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8886 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8887
8888
8889option splice-request
8890no option splice-request
8891 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 yes | yes | yes | yes
8894 Arguments : none
8895
8896 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008897 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008898 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8899 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8900 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8901 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8902
8903 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8904
8905 Example :
8906 option splice-request
8907
8908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8910
8911 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8912 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8913
8914
8915option splice-response
8916no option splice-response
8917 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8919 yes | yes | yes | yes
8920 Arguments : none
8921
8922 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008923 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008924 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8925 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8926 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8927 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8928
8929 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8930
8931 Example :
8932 option splice-response
8933
8934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8936
8937 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8938 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8939
8940
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008941option spop-check
8942 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8944 no | no | no | yes
8945 Arguments : none
8946
8947 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8948 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8949 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8950 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8951
8952 Example :
8953 option spop-check
8954
8955 See also : "option httpchk"
8956
8957
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008958option srvtcpka
8959no option srvtcpka
8960 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8962 yes | no | yes | yes
8963 Arguments : none
8964
8965 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8966 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008967 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008968 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8969
8970 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8971 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8972 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8973 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8974
8975 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8976 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8977 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8978 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8979 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8980
8981 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8982
8983 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8984 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8985 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8986
8987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8989
8990 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8991
8992
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008993option ssl-hello-chk
8994 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8996 yes | no | yes | yes
8997 Arguments : none
8998
8999 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9000 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9001 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9002 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9003 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9004 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9005 hello message.
9006
9007 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9008 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9009 messages, which is appreciable.
9010
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009011 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9012 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9013 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009014
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009015 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9016
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009017
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009018option tcp-check
9019 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9020 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9021 yes | no | yes | yes
9022
9023 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9024 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9025
9026 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9027 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9028 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9029
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009030 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009031 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9032 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9033 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9034 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9035 only.
9036
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009037 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009038 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9039 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9040 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9041 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9042
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009043 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009044 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9045 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009046 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009047 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9048 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9049 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9050 the respective protocols.
9051 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009052 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009053
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009054 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009055
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009056 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9057 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9058 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9059 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009060
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009061 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9062 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9063 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009064
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009065
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009066 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009067 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009068 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009069 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009070
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009071 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009072 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009073 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009074
9075 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9076 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009078 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009079 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009080 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009081 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009082 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009083 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9084 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009085 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009086 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9087 tcp-check expect string +OK
9088
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009089 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009090 (send many headers before analyzing)
9091 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009092 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009093 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9094 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9095 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9096 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009097 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009098
9099
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009100 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009101
9102
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009103option tcp-smart-accept
9104no option tcp-smart-accept
9105 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9107 yes | yes | yes | no
9108 Arguments : none
9109
9110 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9111 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9112 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9113 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9114 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9115 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9116
9117 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9118 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9119 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9120 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9121
9122 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9123 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9124 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009125 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009126
9127 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9128 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9129 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9130
9131 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9132 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9133 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9134
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009135 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9136
9137
9138option tcp-smart-connect
9139no option tcp-smart-connect
9140 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9142 yes | no | yes | yes
9143 Arguments : none
9144
9145 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9146 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9147 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9148 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9149 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9150
9151 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9152 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9153 complex.
9154
9155 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9156 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9157 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9158
9159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9161
9162 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9163
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009164
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009165option tcpka
9166 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9168 yes | yes | yes | yes
9169 Arguments : none
9170
9171 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9172 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009174 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9175
9176 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9177 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9178 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9179 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9180
9181 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9182 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9183 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9184 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9185 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9186
9187 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9188
9189 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9190 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9191 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9192 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9193 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9194 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9195 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9196 backends.
9197
9198 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9199
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009200
9201option tcplog
9202 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009204 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009205 Arguments : none
9206
9207 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9208 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9209 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9210 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9211 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9212 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9213 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9214 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9215
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009216 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009218 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009219
9220
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009221option transparent
9222no option transparent
9223 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009225 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009226 Arguments : none
9227
9228 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9229 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9230 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9231 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9232 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9233 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9234 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9235 appropriate server.
9236
9237 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9238 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9239
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009240 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009241 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009242
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009243
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009244external-check command <command>
9245 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 yes | no | yes | yes
9248
9249 Arguments :
9250 <command> is the external command to run
9251
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009252 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9253
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009254 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009255
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009256 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9257 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9258 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9259 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9260 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9261 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009262
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009263 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9264
9265 Environment variables :
9266 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9267 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9268
9269 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9270
9271 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9272
9273 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9274 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9275 for a UNIX socket).
9276
9277 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9278
9279 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9280
9281 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9282
9283 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9284
9285 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9286
9287 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9288 socket).
9289
9290 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9291 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9292
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009293 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009295 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9296 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9297 failed.
9298
9299 Example :
9300 external-check command /bin/true
9301
9302 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9303
9304
9305external-check path <path>
9306 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9308 yes | no | yes | yes
9309
9310 Arguments :
9311 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9312
9313 The default path is "".
9314
9315 Example :
9316 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9317
9318 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9319 "external-check command"
9320
9321
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009322persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009323persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009324 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9326 yes | no | yes | yes
9327 Arguments :
9328 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009329 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9330 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009331
9332 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9333 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009334 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009335 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9336 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9337 forwarded to this server.
9338
9339 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9340 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9341 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009342 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009343 a single "listen" section.
9344
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009345 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9346 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9347 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9348
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009349 Example :
9350 listen tse-farm
9351 bind :3389
9352 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9353 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9354 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9355 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9356 persist rdp-cookie
9357 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009358 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009359 balance rdp-cookie
9360 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9361 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9362
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009363 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9364 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009365
9366
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009367rate-limit sessions <rate>
9368 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9370 yes | yes | yes | no
9371 Arguments :
9372 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9373 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9374
9375 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9376 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9377 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9378 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9379 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9380 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9381
9382 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9383 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9384 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9385 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9386
9387 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9388 listen smtp
9389 mode tcp
9390 bind :25
9391 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009392 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009393
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009394 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9395 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9396 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009397
9398 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9399
9400
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009401redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9402redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9403redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009404 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9406 no | yes | yes | yes
9407
9408 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009409 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009410
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009412 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009413 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9414 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9415 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009416
9417 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9418 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9419 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9420 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9421 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009422 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9423 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9424 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9425 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009426
9427 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9428 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9429 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9430 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9431 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9432 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009433 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009434 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009435 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9436 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9437 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009438
9439 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009440 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9441 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9442 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009443 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009444 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9445 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9446 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9447 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009448
9449 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009450 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009451
9452 - "drop-query"
9453 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9454 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9455 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9456 with a location-type redirect.
9457
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009458 - "append-slash"
9459 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9460 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9461 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9462 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9463
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009464 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9465 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9466 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9467 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9468 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9469 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9470 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9471
9472 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9473 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9474 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9475 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9476 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9477 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9478 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009479
9480 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9481 acl clear dst_port 80
9482 acl secure dst_port 8080
9483 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009484 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009485 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009486 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9487
9488 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009489 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9490 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9491 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009492 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009493
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009494 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9495 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9496 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9497
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009498 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009499 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009500
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009501 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009502 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9503 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9504 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009506 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009507
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009508
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009509retries <value>
9510 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9512 yes | no | yes | yes
9513 Arguments :
9514 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9515 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9516 default value is 3.
9517
9518 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9519 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9520 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9521
9522 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009523 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9524 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009525
9526 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9527 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9528
9529 See also : "option redispatch"
9530
9531
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009532retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009533 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9534 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9535 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9537 yes | no | yes | yes
9538 Arguments :
9539 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9540 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9541 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9542 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9543
9544 none never retry
9545
9546 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9547 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9548
9549 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9550 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9551 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9552 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9553 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9554 processing the request.
9555
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009556 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9557 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9558 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9559 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9560 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9561 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9562 overflow attack for example).
9563
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009564 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9565 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9566 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9567 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9568 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9569 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9570 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9571 amplify denial of service attacks.
9572
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009573 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9574 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9575 considered to be safe to retry.
9576
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009577 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9578 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9579 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9580 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9581
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009582 all-retryable-errors
9583 retry request for any error that are considered
9584 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9585 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9586 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9587
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009588 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9589 not cumulative.
9590
9591 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9592 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9593 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9594 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9595
9596 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9597 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9598 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9599 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9600 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9601 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9602 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9603 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9604 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9605 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9606 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9607 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9608
9609 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9610 should not use this directive.
9611
9612 The default is "conn-failure".
9613
9614 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9615
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009616server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009617 Declare a server in a backend
9618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9619 no | no | yes | yes
9620 Arguments :
9621 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009622 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009623 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009624
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009625 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9626 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9627 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9628 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009629 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9630 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9631 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9632 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9633 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009634 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9635 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9636 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9637 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9638 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9639 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9640 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009641 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009642 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9643 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9644 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9645 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9646 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9647 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9649 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009650 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9651 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009652
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009653 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009654 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9655 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9656 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9657 adding this value to the client's port.
9658
9659 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9660 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009661 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009662
9663 Examples :
9664 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9665 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009666 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009667 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9668 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9669 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009670
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009671 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9672 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9673 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9674 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9675 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9676
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009677 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9678 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009679
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009680server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009681 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009682 this backend.
9683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 no | no | yes | yes
9685
9686 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9687 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9688 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9689 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9690 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009691
9692 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9693 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9694
9695 global
9696 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9697
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009698 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009699 load-server-state-from-file
9700
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009701 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009702 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009703
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009704server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9705 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9706 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9708 no | no | yes | yes
9709
9710 Arguments:
9711 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9712
9713 <num | range>
9714 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9715 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9716 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9717 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9718
9719 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9720
9721 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9722
9723 <params*>
9724 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9725 keyword.
9726
9727 Examples:
9728 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9729 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9730 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9731
9732 # or
9733 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9734
9735 # would be equivalent to:
9736 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9737 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9738 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9739
9740
9741
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009742source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009743source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009744source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009745 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9747 yes | no | yes | yes
9748 Arguments :
9749 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9750 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009751
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009752 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009753 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9754 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9755 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9756 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9757 supported prefixes are :
9758 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9759 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9760 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009761 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009762 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9763 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009764
9765 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9766 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009767 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9768 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9769 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009770
9771 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9772 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9773 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9774 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9775 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9776 <addr>.
9777
9778 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9779 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9780 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9781 port.
9782
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009783 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9784 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9785 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9786 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009787 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009788 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9789 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9790 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9791 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9792 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9793 HTTP header.
9794
9795 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9796 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009797 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009798 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9799 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9800 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9801 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9802 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9803 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9804 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9805
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009806 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9807 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9808 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9809 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9810 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9811 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9812
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009813 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9814 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9815 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9816 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9817
9818 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9819 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9820 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9821 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9822 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9823 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9824
9825 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9826 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9827 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9828 there are two methods :
9829
9830 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9831 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9832 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9833 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9834 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9835 of the client ranges may be used.
9836
9837 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9838 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9839 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9840 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9841 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9842 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9843 same session.
9844
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009845 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9846 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9847 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009848 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009849
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009850 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9851
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009852 Examples :
9853 backend private
9854 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9855 source 192.168.1.200
9856
9857 backend transparent_ssl1
9858 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9859 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9860
9861 backend transparent_ssl2
9862 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9863 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9864 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9865
9866 backend transparent_ssl3
9867 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9868 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9869 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9870
9871 backend transparent_smtp
9872 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9873 # with Tproxy version 4.
9874 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9875
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009876 backend transparent_http
9877 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9878 # proxy.
9879 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009881 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009882 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9883
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009884
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009885srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9886 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9887 the connection on the server side.
9888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9889 yes | no | yes | yes
9890 Arguments :
9891 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9892
9893 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9894 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009895 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9896 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009897
9898 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9899
9900
9901srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9902 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9903 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9904 server side.
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9906 yes | no | yes | yes
9907 Arguments :
9908 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9909 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9910 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9911 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9912
9913 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9914 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009915 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9916 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009917
9918 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9919
9920
9921srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9922 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9924 yes | no | yes | yes
9925 Arguments :
9926 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9927 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9928 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9929 document.
9930
9931 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9932 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009933 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9934 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009935
9936 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9937
9938
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009939stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9940 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009942 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009943
9944 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9945 matched.
9946
9947 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9948 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9949
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009950 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9951 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009952 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009953
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009954 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9955 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9956 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9957 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009958
9959 Example :
9960 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9961 backend stats_localhost
9962 stats enable
9963 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9964
9965 Example :
9966 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9967 backend stats_auth
9968 stats enable
9969 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9970 stats admin if TRUE
9971
9972 Example :
9973 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9974 userlist stats-auth
9975 group admin users admin
9976 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9977 group readonly users haproxy
9978 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9979
9980 backend stats_auth
9981 stats enable
9982 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9983 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9984 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9985 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9986
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009987 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9988 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9989 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009990
9991
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009992stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9993 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009995 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009996 Arguments :
9997 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9998
9999 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10000
10001 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10002 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10003 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10004 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10005 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10006 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10007
10008 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10009 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10010 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010011 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010012
10013 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10014 report using "stats scope".
10015
10016 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10017 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10018 unobvious parameters.
10019
10020 Example :
10021 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10022 backend public_www
10023 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10024 stats enable
10025 stats hide-version
10026 stats scope .
10027 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010028 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010029 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10030 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10031
10032 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10033 backend private_monitoring
10034 stats enable
10035 stats uri /admin?stats
10036 stats refresh 5s
10037
10038 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10039
10040
10041stats enable
10042 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010045 Arguments : none
10046
10047 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10048 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10049 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10050 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10051 - stats auth : no authentication
10052 - stats scope : no restriction
10053
10054 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10055 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10056 unobvious parameters.
10057
10058 Example :
10059 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10060 backend public_www
10061 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10062 stats enable
10063 stats hide-version
10064 stats scope .
10065 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010066 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010067 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10068 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10069
10070 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10071 backend private_monitoring
10072 stats enable
10073 stats uri /admin?stats
10074 stats refresh 5s
10075
10076 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10077
10078
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010079stats hide-version
10080 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010082 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010083 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010084
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010085 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10086 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10087 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10088 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10089 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10090 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010092 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10093 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10094 unobvious parameters.
10095
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010096 Example :
10097 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10098 backend public_www
10099 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010100 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010101 stats hide-version
10102 stats scope .
10103 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010104 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010105 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10106 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010107
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010108 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10109 backend private_monitoring
10110 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010111 stats uri /admin?stats
10112 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010114 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010115
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010116
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010117stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10118 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10119 Access control for statistics
10120
10121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10122 no | no | yes | yes
10123
10124 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10125 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10126 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10127 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10128 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10129 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10130
10131 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10132 instance.
10133
10134 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10135 about ACL usage.
10136
10137
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010138stats realm <realm>
10139 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010141 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010142 Arguments :
10143 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10144 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10145 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10146
10147 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10148 using a backslash ('\').
10149
10150 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10151 only related to authentication.
10152
10153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10155 unobvious parameters.
10156
10157 Example :
10158 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10159 backend public_www
10160 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10161 stats enable
10162 stats hide-version
10163 stats scope .
10164 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010165 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010166 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10167 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10168
10169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10170 backend private_monitoring
10171 stats enable
10172 stats uri /admin?stats
10173 stats refresh 5s
10174
10175 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10176
10177
10178stats refresh <delay>
10179 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010181 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010182 Arguments :
10183 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10184 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10185 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10186 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10187 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10188 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10189
10190 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10191 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10192 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010193 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010194
10195 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10196 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10197 unobvious parameters.
10198
10199 Example :
10200 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10201 backend public_www
10202 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10203 stats enable
10204 stats hide-version
10205 stats scope .
10206 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010207 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010208 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10209 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10210
10211 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10212 backend private_monitoring
10213 stats enable
10214 stats uri /admin?stats
10215 stats refresh 5s
10216
10217 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10218
10219
10220stats scope { <name> | "." }
10221 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010224 Arguments :
10225 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10226 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10227 section in which the statement appears.
10228
10229 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10230 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10231 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10232 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10233 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10234 exists.
10235
10236 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10237 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10238 unobvious parameters.
10239
10240 Example :
10241 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10242 backend public_www
10243 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10244 stats enable
10245 stats hide-version
10246 stats scope .
10247 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010248 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010249 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10250 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10251
10252 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10253 backend private_monitoring
10254 stats enable
10255 stats uri /admin?stats
10256 stats refresh 5s
10257
10258 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10259
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010260
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010261stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010262 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010264 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010265
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010266 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010267 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10268
10269 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10270 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10271
10272 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10273 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010275
10276 Example :
10277 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10278 backend private_monitoring
10279 stats enable
10280 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10281 stats uri /admin?stats
10282 stats refresh 5s
10283
10284 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10285 global section.
10286
10287
10288stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010289 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10291 yes | yes | yes | yes
10292 Arguments : none
10293
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010294 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010295 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10296 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10297 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10298 - IP (socket, server)
10299 - cookie (backend, server)
10300
10301 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10302 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010303 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010304
10305 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10306
10307
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010308stats show-modules
10309 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10311 yes | yes | yes | yes
10312 Arguments : none
10313
10314 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10315 values as a tooltip.
10316
10317 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10318 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10319 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10320
10321 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10322
10323
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010324stats show-node [ <name> ]
10325 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010328 Arguments:
10329 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10330 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10331
10332 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10333 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010334 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010335
10336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10338 unobvious parameters.
10339
10340 Example:
10341 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10342 backend private_monitoring
10343 stats enable
10344 stats show-node Europe-1
10345 stats uri /admin?stats
10346 stats refresh 5s
10347
10348 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10349 section.
10350
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010351
10352stats uri <prefix>
10353 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010355 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 Arguments :
10357 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10358 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10359 query string.
10360
10361 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10362 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10363 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10364 possible to reach it in the application.
10365
10366 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010367 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010368 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10369 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10370 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10371 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10372
10373 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10374 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10375 an address or a port to statistics only.
10376
10377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10379 unobvious parameters.
10380
10381 Example :
10382 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10383 backend public_www
10384 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10385 stats enable
10386 stats hide-version
10387 stats scope .
10388 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010389 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10391 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10392
10393 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10394 backend private_monitoring
10395 stats enable
10396 stats uri /admin?stats
10397 stats refresh 5s
10398
10399 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10400
10401
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010402stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10403 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010405 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010406
10407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010408 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010409 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010410 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010411 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10412
10413 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10414 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10415 the "stick-table" statement.
10416
10417 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10418 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10419 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10420 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10421 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10422
10423 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10424 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10425 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10426 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10427 transformation rules.
10428
10429 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10430 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10431 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10432 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10433 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10434 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10435 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10436
10437 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10438 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10439 ACL based conditions.
10440
10441 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10442 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10443 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10444 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10445
10446 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10447 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10448 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10449 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10450
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010451 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10452 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010454
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010455 Example :
10456 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10457 # last 30 minutes
10458 backend pop
10459 mode tcp
10460 balance roundrobin
10461 stick store-request src
10462 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10463 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10464 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10465
10466 backend smtp
10467 mode tcp
10468 balance roundrobin
10469 stick match src table pop
10470 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10471 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10472
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010473 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010474 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010475
10476
10477stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10478 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10480 no | no | yes | yes
10481
10482 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10483 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10484 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10485 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10486
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010487 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10488 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010489 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010490
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010491 Examples :
10492 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010493 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010494
10495 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10496 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10497 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10498
10499
10500 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10501 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10502 backend http
10503 mode http
10504 balance roundrobin
10505 stick on src table https
10506 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10507 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10508 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10509
10510 backend https
10511 mode tcp
10512 balance roundrobin
10513 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10514 stick on src
10515 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10516 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10517
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010518 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010519
10520
10521stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10522 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10524 no | no | yes | yes
10525
10526 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010527 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010528 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010529 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010530 server is selected.
10531
10532 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10533 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10534 the "stick-table" statement.
10535
10536 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10537 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10538 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10539 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10540 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10541 address.
10542
10543 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10544 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10545 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10546 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10547 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10548 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10549 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10550 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10551 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10552 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10553
10554 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10555 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10556 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10557 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10558 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10559 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10560 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10561
10562 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10563 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10564 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10565 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10566
10567 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10568 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10569 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10570 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10571 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10572 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010573 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10574 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10575 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10576 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10577 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10578 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010579
10580 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10581 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10582 the request.
10583
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010584 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10585 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010586 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010587
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010588 Example :
10589 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10590 # last 30 minutes
10591 backend pop
10592 mode tcp
10593 balance roundrobin
10594 stick store-request src
10595 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10596 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10597 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10598
10599 backend smtp
10600 mode tcp
10601 balance roundrobin
10602 stick match src table pop
10603 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10604 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10605
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010606 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010607 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010608
10609
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010610stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010611 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10612 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010613 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010615 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010616
10617 Arguments :
10618 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10619 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10620 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10621 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10622
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010623 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10624 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10625 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10626 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10627
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010628 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10629 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10630 instance.
10631
10632 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10633 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10634 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10635 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10636 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10637 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010638 to 32 characters.
10639
10640 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10641 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10642 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010643 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010644 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10645 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010646
10647 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010648 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10649 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010650 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10651 increase.
10652
10653 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010654 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10655 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10656 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010657
10658 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10659 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10660 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10661 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010662 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010663 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10664 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10665 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10666 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10667 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10668 parameter (see below).
10669
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010670 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10671 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10672 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10673 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10674 soft restart.
10675
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010676 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10677 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010678
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010679 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10680 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10681 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10682 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010683 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010684 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010685 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10686 if not expiration delay is specified.
10687
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010688 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10689 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10690 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10691 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010692 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10693 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10694 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10695 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10696 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10697 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10698 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10699 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10700 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10701 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10702 types and their arguments.
10703
10704 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10705 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10706 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10707 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10708
10709 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10710 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10711 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010712 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010713
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010714 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10715 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10716 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010717 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010718 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010719 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010720
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010721 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10722 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10723 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10724 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10725
10726 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10727 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10728 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10729 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10730 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10731 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10732
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010733 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10734 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10735 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10736 they were received.
10737
10738 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10739 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10740 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10741 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10742 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10743
10744 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10745 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10746 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10747 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10748 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10749
10750 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10751 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10752 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10753
10754 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10755 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10756 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10757 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10758 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10759
10760 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10761 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10762 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10763 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10764 the client side.
10765
10766 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10769 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10770 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10771 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10772 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10773
10774 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10775 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10776 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10777 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10778 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10779 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010780 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010781
10782 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10783 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10784 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10785 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10786 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10787 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10788
10789 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010790 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010791 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10792 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10793
10794 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10795 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10796 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10797 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10798 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10799 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10800 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10801 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10802 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10803 recommended for better fairness.
10804
10805 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010807 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10808 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10809
10810 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10811 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10812 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10813 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10814 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10815 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10816 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10817 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10818 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10819 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010820
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010821 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10822 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010823 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10824 reference it.
10825
10826 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10827 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010828 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10829 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10830 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010831
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010832 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10833 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10834 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10835 something that can be ignored.
10836
10837 Example:
10838 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10839 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10840 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10841 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10842
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010843 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010844 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010845
10846
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010847stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010848 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10850 no | no | yes | yes
10851
10852 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010853 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010854 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010855 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010856 server is selected.
10857
10858 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10859 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10860 the "stick-table" statement.
10861
10862 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10863 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10864 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10865 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10866
10867 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10868 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10869 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10870 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10871 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10872 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010873 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010874 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10875 rules.
10876
10877 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10878 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10879 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10880 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10881 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10882 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10883 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10884
10885 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10886 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10887 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10888 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10889
10890 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10891 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10892 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10893 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10894 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10895 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010896 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10897 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10898 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10899 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10900 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10901 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10902 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10903 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10904 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010905
10906 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10907
10908 Example :
10909 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10910 backend https
10911 mode tcp
10912 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010913 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010914 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010915
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010916 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10917 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10918
10919 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10920 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10921 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10922
10923 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10924 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010925
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010926 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10927 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10928 # at offset 44.
10929
10930 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10931 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10932
10933 # Learn on response if server hello.
10934 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010935
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010936 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10937 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10938
10939 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10940 extraction.
10941
10942
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010943tcp-check comment <string>
10944 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10945 it fails.
10946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10947 yes | no | yes | yes
10948
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010949 Arguments :
10950 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10951 rule fails.
10952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010953 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10954 user-friendly error reporting.
10955
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010956 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10957 "tcp-check expect".
10958
10959
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010960tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10961 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010962 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010963 Opens a new connection
10964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010966
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010967 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010968 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10969
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010970 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010971 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010972
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010973 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010974 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10975 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010976 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010977
10978 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010979
10980 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10981
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010982 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10983
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010984 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10985
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010986 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10987
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010988 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10989 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10990 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10991 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10992
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010993 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10994 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10995 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10996 haproxy -vv.
10997
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010998 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010999
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011000 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11001 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11002 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11003
11004 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11005 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11006 of the sequence.
11007
11008 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11009 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11010 do.
11011
11012 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11013 unset-var or comment rules.
11014
11015 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011016 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11017 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11018 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11019 option tcp-check
11020 tcp-check connect
11021 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11022 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11023 tcp-check send \r\n
11024 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11025 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11026 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11027 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11028 tcp-check send \r\n
11029 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11030 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11031
11032 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11033 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011034 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011035 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11036 tcp-check connect port 143
11037 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11038 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11039
11040 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11041
11042
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011043tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011044 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011045 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011046 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011047 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011049 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011050
11051 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011052 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11053
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011054 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11055 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11056 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11057 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11058 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11059 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11060 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11061 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11062 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11063 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11064
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011065 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011066 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11067 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011068 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11069 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11070 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11071
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011072 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11073 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11074 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011075 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11076 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11077 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11078 example 404 with disable-on-404
11079 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11080 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011081 By default "L7OK" is used.
11082
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011083 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11084 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011085 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11086 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11087 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11088 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11089 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11090 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011091
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011092 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011093 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011094 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11095 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11096 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11097 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011098 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11099
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011100 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11101 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11102 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11103 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11104
11105 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11106 informational message reported in logs if an error
11107 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11108 log-format string.
11109
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011110 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11111 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11112 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11113 followed by some converters.
11114
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011115 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11116 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11117 with the usual backslash ('\').
11118 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011119 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011120 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11121 used upper or lower case.
11122
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011123 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11124
11125 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11126 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11127 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11128 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11129 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11130 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11131 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11132 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11133
11134 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11135 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11136 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11137 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11138 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11139 expression.
11140
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011141 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11142 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11143 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11144 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11145 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11146 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11147
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011148 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11149 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11150 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11151 this exact hexadecimal string.
11152 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11153
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011154 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11155 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11156 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11157 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11158 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11159 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11160 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11161 size.
11162
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011163 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11164 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11165 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11166 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11167 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11168 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11169 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11170 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11171 in a binary string before matching the response's
11172 buffer.
11173
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011174 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011175 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011176 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11177 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11178 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11179 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11180 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11181 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11182 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11183 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11184 the null character.
11185
11186 Examples :
11187 # perform a POP check
11188 option tcp-check
11189 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11190
11191 # perform an IMAP check
11192 option tcp-check
11193 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11194
11195 # look for the redis master server
11196 option tcp-check
11197 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011198 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011199 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11200 tcp-check expect string role:master
11201 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11202 tcp-check expect string +OK
11203
11204
11205 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011206 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011207
11208
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011209tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11210tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11211 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11212 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011215
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011216 Arguments :
11217 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11218
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011219 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11220 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011221
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011222 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11223 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011224
11225 Examples :
11226 # look for the redis master server
11227 option tcp-check
11228 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11229 tcp-check expect string role:master
11230
11231 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011232 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011233
11234
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011235tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11236tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11237 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11238 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011240 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011241
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011242 Arguments :
11243 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011244
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011245 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11246 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011247
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011248 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11249 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11250 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011251
11252 Examples :
11253 # redis check in binary
11254 option tcp-check
11255 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11256 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11257
11258
11259 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011260 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011261
11262
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011263tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011264 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011266 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011267
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011268 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011269 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11270 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11271 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11272 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11273 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11274 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11275 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11276 and '-'.
11277
11278 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11279
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011280 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011281 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11282
11283
11284tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011285 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011287 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011288
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011289 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11291 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11294 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11295 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11296 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11297 and '-'.
11298
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011299 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011300 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11301
11302
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011303tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11304 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11306 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011308 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11309 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011311 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011312
11313 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11314 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011315 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11316 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11317 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11318 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11319 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11320 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011321
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011322 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11323 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11324 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11325 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011326
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011327 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011328 - accept :
11329 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11330 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11331 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011333 - reject :
11334 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11335 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11336 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11337 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11338 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11339 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11340 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11341 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11342 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11343 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11344 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011345 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011346
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011347 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11348 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11349 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11350 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11351 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11352 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11353 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11354 hosts.
11355
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011356 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11357 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11358 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11359 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11360 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11361 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11362 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11363 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11364
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011365 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11366 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11367 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11368 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11369 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11370 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11371 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11372 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11373 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011374 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11375 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011376
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011377 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011378 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011379 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11380 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11381 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011382 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011383 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011384 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11385 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11386 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11387 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11388 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11389 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11390 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011391
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011392 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011393 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011395 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011396 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11397 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11398 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011400 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11401 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11402 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11403 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011404
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011405 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11406 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11407 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11408 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11409 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011410 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11411 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11412 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11413 layer7 information is extracted.
11414
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011415 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11416 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11417 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11418 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11419 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011420
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011421 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11422 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11423 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11424 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11425
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011426 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11427 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11428 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11429 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11430
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011431 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11432 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11433 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11434 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11435 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011436
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011437 - set-src <expr> :
11438 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11439 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11440 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011441 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011443 Arguments:
11444 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11445 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011446
11447 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011448 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11449
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011450 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11451 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011452
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011453 - set-src-port <expr> :
11454 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11455 expression.
11456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011457 Arguments:
11458 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11459 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011460
11461 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011462 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11463
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011464 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11465 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11466 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011467
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011468 - set-dst <expr> :
11469 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11470 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11471 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11472 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11473 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11474
11475 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11476 followed by some converters.
11477
11478 Example:
11479
11480 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11481 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11482
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011483 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11484 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11485
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011486 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11487 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11488 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11489 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11490
11491
11492 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11493 followed by some converters.
11494
11495 Example:
11496
11497 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11498
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011499 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11500 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11501 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11502
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011503 - "silent-drop" :
11504 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011506 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11507 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11508 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11509 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11510 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011511 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11512 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011513 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11514 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011515 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011516 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11517 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11518 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11519 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011521 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11522 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11523 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011525 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11526 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11527 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011529 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011530 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011531 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011533 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11534 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11535 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011537 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011538 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11539 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011540
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011541 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11542
11543 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11544
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011545 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11546
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011547 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011548
11549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011550tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11551 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011553 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011555 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11556 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011558 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011561 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11562 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11563 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11564 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011566 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11567 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11568 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11569 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011570 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11571 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11572 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11573 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11574 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11575 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011576 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011577 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011579 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11580 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11581 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11582 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011583
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011584 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011585 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011586 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011587 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11588 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011589 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011590 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011591 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011592 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011593 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011594 - set-dst <expr>
11595 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011596 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011597 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011598 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011599 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011600 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011602 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11603 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011604 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11605 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011606
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011607 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11608 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11609 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11610 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11611 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11612 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011614 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011615 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11616 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011617
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011618 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11619 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11620 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11621 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11622 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11623 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011625 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011626 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11627 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11628 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11629 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11630 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11631 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11632 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11633 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11634 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11635 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011636
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011637 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011638 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11639 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11640 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011641
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011642 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11643 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11644
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011645 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011646 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11647 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011648
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011649 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11650 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011654 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011656 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11658 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011659 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011660 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11661 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011662
11663 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11664 followed by some converters.
11665
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011666 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11667 <var-name>.
11668
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011669 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11670 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11671 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11672 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11673 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11674
11675 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11676 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11677 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11678 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11679 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11680 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11681 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11682 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11683 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11684 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11685 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11686
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011687 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11688 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11689 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11690 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11691 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11692
11693 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11694
11695 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11696
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011697 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11698 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11699 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11700 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11701 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11702 evaluated.
11703
11704 Example:
11705 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11706
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011707 Example:
11708
11709 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011710 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011711
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011712 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011713 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11714 # and reject everything else.
11715 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11716 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011717 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011718 tcp-request content reject
11719
11720 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011721 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11722 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11723 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011724 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011725
11726 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11727 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11728 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011729 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011730 tcp-request content reject
11731
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011732 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011733 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011734 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011735 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011736 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11737 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011738
11739 Example:
11740 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11741 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011742 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011744 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011745 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011746
11747 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011748 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011749 # protecting all our sites
11750 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011751 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11752 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011753 ...
11754 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11755
11756 backend http_dynamic
11757 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011758 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011759 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011760 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011761 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011762 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011763 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011765 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011766
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011767 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11768 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769
11770
11771tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11772 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011774 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011775 Arguments :
11776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11778 as explained at the top of this document.
11779
11780 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11781 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11782 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11783 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11784 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11785
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011786 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11787 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11788 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11789 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11790
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11792 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011793 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011794 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011795 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11796 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11797 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11798 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011799
11800 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11801 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11802 it pass through unaffected.
11803
11804 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11805 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11806 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011807 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011808 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11809 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011810 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11811 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11812 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011813
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011814 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011815 "timeout client".
11816
11817
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011818tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11819 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11821 no | no | yes | yes
11822 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011823 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11824 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011825
11826 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11827
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011828 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011829 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11830 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011831 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11832 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011833
11834 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11835
11836 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11837 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11838 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11839 inserted.
11840
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011841 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011842 - accept :
11843 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11844 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11845 the rules evaluation.
11846
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011847 - close :
11848 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11849 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11850 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11851 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11852 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11853 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011854 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011855 protocols.
11856
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011857 - reject :
11858 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11859 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011860 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011861
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011862 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11863 Sets a variable.
11864
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011865 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11866 Unsets a variable.
11867
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011868 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11869 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11870 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11871 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11872
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011873 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11874 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11875 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11876 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11877
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011878 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11879 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11880 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11881 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11882 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011883
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011884 - "silent-drop" :
11885 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011887 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11888 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11889 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11890 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11891 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011892 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11893 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011894 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11895 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011896 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011897 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11898 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11899 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11900 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11901
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011902 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11903 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11904
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011905 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11906 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11907 for changing the default action to a reject.
11908
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011909 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11910 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11911 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11912 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011913 period.
11914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011915 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11916 declared inline.
11917
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011918 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11919 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011920 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011923 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011924 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011925 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011926 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11927 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011928 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011929 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11930 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011931
11932 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11933 followed by some converters.
11934
11935 Example:
11936
11937 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11938
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011939 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11940 <var-name>.
11941
11942 Example:
11943
11944 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11945
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011946 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11947 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11948 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11949 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11950 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11951
11952 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11953
11954 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11955
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011956 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11957
11958 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11959
11960
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011961tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11962 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11964 no | yes | yes | no
11965 Arguments :
11966 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11967 below.
11968
11969 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011972 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11973 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11974 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11975 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11976 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11977 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11978 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011979 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011980 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11981 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11982 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11983 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11984 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11985 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11986 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11987 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11988 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11989 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11990 instead.
11991
11992 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11993 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11994 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11995 rules which may be inserted.
11996
11997 Several types of actions are supported :
11998 - accept : the request is accepted
11999 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12000 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12001 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012002 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012003 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012004 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012005 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012006 - silent-drop
12007
12008 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12009 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12010 sections for a complete description.
12011
12012 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12013 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12014 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12015
12016 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12017 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12018 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12019 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12020 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12021
12022 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12023 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12024
12025 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12026 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12027 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12028
12029 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12030 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12031 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12032
12033 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12034 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12035 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12036
12037 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12038 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12039 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12040
12041 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12042
12043 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12044
12045
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012046tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12047 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12049 no | no | yes | yes
12050 Arguments :
12051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12053 as explained at the top of this document.
12054
12055 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12056
12057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012058timeout check <timeout>
12059 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12060 established.
12061
12062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12063 yes | no | yes | yes
12064 Arguments:
12065 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12067 as explained at the top of this document.
12068
12069 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12070 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012071 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012072 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012073 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12074 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12075 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012076
12077 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12078 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12079
12080 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12081 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012082 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012083
12084 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12085 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12086 forget about it.
12087
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012088 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12089 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012090
12091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012092timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012093 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12095 yes | yes | yes | no
12096 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012097 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12099 as explained at the top of this document.
12100
12101 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12102 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12103 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012104 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12105 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12106 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12107 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012108 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12109 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12110 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012111 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012112 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012113 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12114 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012115 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12116 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012117
12118 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12119 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12120 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12121 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012122 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012123 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12124
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012125 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012126
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012127 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012129
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012130timeout client-fin <timeout>
12131 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12133 yes | yes | yes | no
12134 Arguments :
12135 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12136 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12137 as explained at the top of this document.
12138
12139 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12140 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12141 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12142 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12143 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12144 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12145 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012146 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12147 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12148 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012149
12150 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12151 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12152 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12153
12154 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12155
12156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012157timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012158 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12160 yes | no | yes | yes
12161 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012162 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12164 as explained at the top of this document.
12165
12166 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012167 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012168 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012169 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012170 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12171 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012172
12173 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12174 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12175 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12176 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012177 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012178 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12179
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012180 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012182
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012183timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12184 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12186 yes | yes | yes | yes
12187 Arguments :
12188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12190 as explained at the top of this document.
12191
12192 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12193 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12194 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12195 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12196 once the request has started to present itself.
12197
12198 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12199 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12200 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12201 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12202 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12203
12204 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12205 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12206 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12207 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12208
12209 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12210 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012211 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012212 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12213 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012214 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012215
12216 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12217 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12218 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12219 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12220
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012221 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12222 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012223 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12224
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012225 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12226
12227
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012228timeout http-request <timeout>
12229 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012231 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012232 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012233 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012234 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12235 as explained at the top of this document.
12236
12237 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12238 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12239 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12240 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12241 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12242 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12243 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012244 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12245 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12246 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12247 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012248 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012249 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12250 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012251
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012252 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12253 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12254 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12255 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12256 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012257 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012258
12259 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12260 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012261 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012262 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12263 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12264
12265 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012266 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12267 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12268 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012269
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012270 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012271 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012272
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012273
12274timeout queue <timeout>
12275 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12277 yes | no | yes | yes
12278 Arguments :
12279 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12281 as explained at the top of this document.
12282
12283 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12284 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12285 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12286 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12287 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12288
12289 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12290 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12291 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12292 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12293
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012294 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012295
12296
12297timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012298 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12300 yes | no | yes | yes
12301 Arguments :
12302 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12303 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12304 as explained at the top of this document.
12305
12306 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12307 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12308 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12309 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12310 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12311 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12312 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12313
12314 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12315 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12316 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12317 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12318 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012319 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012320 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012321 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12322 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012323 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12324 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012325
12326 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12327 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12328 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12329 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012330 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012331 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12332
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012333 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012334
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012335
12336timeout server-fin <timeout>
12337 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12339 yes | no | yes | yes
12340 Arguments :
12341 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12342 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12343 as explained at the top of this document.
12344
12345 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12346 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12347 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12348 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12349 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12350 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12351 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12352 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12353 situations, it should not be needed.
12354
12355 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12356 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12357 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12358
12359 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12360
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012361
12362timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012363 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12365 yes | yes | yes | yes
12366 Arguments :
12367 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12369 as explained at the top of this document.
12370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012371 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12372 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12373 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012374
12375 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12376 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12377 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12378 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012379 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012380
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012381 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012382
12383
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012384timeout tunnel <timeout>
12385 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12387 yes | no | yes | yes
12388 Arguments :
12389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12391 as explained at the top of this document.
12392
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012393 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012394 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12395 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12396 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012397 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12398 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012399 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12400 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12401 specified.
12402
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012403 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12404 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12405 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12406 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12407 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12408 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12409 state.
12410
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012411 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12412 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12413 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12414 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012415 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012416
12417 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12418 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12419 forget about it.
12420
12421 Example :
12422 defaults http
12423 option http-server-close
12424 timeout connect 5s
12425 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012426 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012427 timeout server 30s
12428 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12429
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012430 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012431
12432
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012433transparent (deprecated)
12434 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012436 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012437 Arguments : none
12438
12439 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12440 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12441 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12442 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12443 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12444 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12445 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12446 appropriate server.
12447
12448 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12449
12450 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12451 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12452
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012453 See also: "option transparent"
12454
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012455unique-id-format <string>
12456 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12458 yes | yes | yes | no
12459 Arguments :
12460 <string> is a log-format string.
12461
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012462 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12463 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12464 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12465 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012466
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012467 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12468 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12469 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12470 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12471 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12472 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12473 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12474 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012475
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012476 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12477 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012478
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012479 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012480
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012481 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012482
12483 will generate:
12484
12485 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12486
12487 See also: "unique-id-header"
12488
12489unique-id-header <name>
12490 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12492 yes | yes | yes | no
12493 Arguments :
12494 <name> is the name of the header.
12495
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012496 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12497 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012498
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012499 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012500
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012501 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012502 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12503
12504 will generate:
12505
12506 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12507
12508 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012509
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012510use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012511 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12513 no | yes | yes | no
12514 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012515 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12516 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012517
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012518 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12519 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012520
12521 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12522 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12523 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012524 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012525 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012526 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12527 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012528
12529 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12530 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12531 assign the backend.
12532
12533 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12534 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12535 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12536 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12537 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12538 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12539
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012540 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012541 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012542 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12543 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12544 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12545
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012546 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12547 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12548 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12549 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12550 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12551 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12552 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12553 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12554 cannot be forced from the request.
12555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012556 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012557 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12558 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12559
12560 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12561 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012562
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012563use-fcgi-app <name>
12564 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12566 no | no | yes | yes
12567 Arguments :
12568 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12569
12570 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012571
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012572use-server <server> if <condition>
12573use-server <server> unless <condition>
12574 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12576 no | no | yes | yes
12577 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012578 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12579 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012580
12581 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12582
12583 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12584 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12585 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12586
12587 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12588 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12589 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12590 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12591 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12592 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12593 matches will assign the server.
12594
12595 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12596 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12597 with the next rules until one matches.
12598
12599 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12600 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12601 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12602 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12603
12604 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12605 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12606 stripped.
12607
12608 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12609 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012610 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12611 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12612 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012613
12614 Example :
12615 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12616 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12617 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12618 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012619 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012620 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012621 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012622 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12623 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12624
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012625 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12626 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12627 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12628 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012629 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012630 and we fall back to load balancing.
12631
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012632 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012634
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126355. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012636--------------------------
12637
12638The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12639depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12640settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12641written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12642described in this section.
12643
12644
126455.1. Bind options
12646-----------------
12647
12648The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12649as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12650no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12651parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12652while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12653provided immediately after the setting name.
12654
12655The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12656
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012657accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12658 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12659 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12660 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12661 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12662 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12663 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12664 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12665 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12666 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012667 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12668 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12669 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012671accept-proxy
12672 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012673 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12674 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012675 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12676 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12677 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12678 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012679 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012680 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12681 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012682 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12683 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012684
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012685allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012686 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012687 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012688 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012689 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12690 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012691
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012692alpn <protocols>
12693 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12694 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12695 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012696 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012697 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012698 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12699 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12700 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12701 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12702 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12703 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12704 preference, like below :
12705
12706 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012708backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012709 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012710 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12711
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012712curves <curves>
12713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12714 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12715 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12716 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12717 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12718 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12719
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012720ecdhe <named curve>
12721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012722 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12723 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012724
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012725ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12727 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12728 client's certificate.
12729
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012730ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12731 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12732 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12733 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12734 error is ignored.
12735
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012736ca-sign-file <cafile>
12737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12738 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12739 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12740 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12741 'generate-certificates' for details.
12742
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012743ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012744 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12745 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12746 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12747 'generate-certificates' for details.
12748
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012749ca-verify-file <cafile>
12750 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12751 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12752 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12753 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12754 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012756ciphers <ciphers>
12757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12758 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012759 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012760 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012761 information and recommendations see e.g.
12762 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12763 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12764 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12765
12766ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12768 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12769 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12770 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012771 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12772 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012773
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012774crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12776 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12777 to verify client's certificate.
12778
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012779crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12781 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12782 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12783 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12784 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012785 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12786 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012787
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012788 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12789 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12790
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012791 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12792 are loaded.
12793
12794 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012795 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12796 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12797 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12798 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12799 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12800 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12801 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012802 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012803
12804 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12805 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12806 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12807 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012808 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12809 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012810
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012811 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012813 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012814 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012815 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12816 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012817 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12818 clients).
12819
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012820 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12821 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12822 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12823 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12824 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12825 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12826 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12827 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12828 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12829 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12830 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12831 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12832 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12833
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012834 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12835 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12836 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12837 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12838 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12839
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012840 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12841 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12842 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12843 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012844
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012845 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12846 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12847 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012848
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012849crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012851 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012852 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012853 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012854
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012855crt-list <file>
12856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012857 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12858 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012859
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012860 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12861
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012862 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12863 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12864 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12865 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12866 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012867
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012868 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012869 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12870 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12871 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12872 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12873 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012874 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12875 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12876 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012877
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012878 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12879 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12880 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012881
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012882 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12883
Joao Morais5ae6bfc2020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012884 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12885 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12886 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12887 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12888 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12889 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12890 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12891 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012892
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012893 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012894 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012895 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012896 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012897 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012898 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012900defer-accept
12901 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12902 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12903 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012904 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012905 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12906 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12907 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12908 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12909 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12910 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12911 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12912
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012913expose-fd listeners
12914 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12915 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012916 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12917 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012918 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012919
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012920force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012921 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012922 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012923 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012924 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012925
12926force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012927 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012928 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012929 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012930
12931force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012932 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012933 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012934 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012935
12936force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012937 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012938 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012939 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012940
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012941force-tlsv13
12942 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12943 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012944 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012945
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012946generate-certificates
12947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12948 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12949 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12950 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12951 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12952 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12953 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12954 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12955 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12956 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12957 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12958
12959 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12960 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012961 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012962 certificate is used many times.
12963
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012964gid <gid>
12965 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12966 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12967 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12968 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12969 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12970
12971group <group>
12972 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12973 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12974 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12975 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12976 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12977
12978id <id>
12979 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12980 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12981 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12982 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12983
12984interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012985 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12986 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12987 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12988 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12989 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12990 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012991 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12992 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12993 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12994 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12995 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12996 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012997
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012998level <level>
12999 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13000 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13001 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013002 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013003 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13004 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13005 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013006 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013007 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013008 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013009 all counters).
13010
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013011severity-output <format>
13012 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13013 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13014 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13015 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13016 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13017 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13018 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13019 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13020 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13021 rfc5424 convention.
13022
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013023maxconn <maxconn>
13024 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13025 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13026 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13027 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13028 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13029 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13030 eat all memory.
13031
13032mode <mode>
13033 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13034 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13035 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13036 UNIX sockets.
13037
13038mss <maxseg>
13039 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13040 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13041 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13042 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13043 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13044 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13045 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13046 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13047 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13048 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13049 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13050
13051name <name>
13052 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13053 page.
13054
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013055namespace <name>
13056 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13057 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13058 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13059 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13060
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013061nice <nice>
13062 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13063 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13064 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13065 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13066 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13067 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13068 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13069 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13070 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13071 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13072 one for an RDP socket.
13073
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013074no-ca-names
13075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13076 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013077 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013078
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013079no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013081 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013082 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013083 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013084 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13085 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013086
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013087no-tls-tickets
13088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13089 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13090 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013091 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13092 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013093 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13094 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13095 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013096
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013097no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013099 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013100 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013101 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013102 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13103 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013104
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013105no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013107 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013108 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013109 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013110 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13111 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013112
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013113no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013115 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013116 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013117 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013118 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13119 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013120
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013121no-tlsv13
13122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13123 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13124 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13125 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013126 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13127 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013128
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013129npn <protocols>
13130 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13131 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13132 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013133 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013134 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013135 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13136 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13137 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13138 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13139 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013140
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013141prefer-client-ciphers
13142 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13143 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13144 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013145 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13146 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13147 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013148
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013149process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013150 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013151 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013152 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013153 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13154 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13155 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13156 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013158 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13159 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13160 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13161 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13162 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013163
13164 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13165
13166 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13167 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13168 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13169 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13170 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13171 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13172 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13173 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013174
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013175proto <name>
13176 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13177 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13178 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13179 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013180 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013181 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013182 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013183 h2" on the bind line.
13184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013185ssl
13186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013187 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013188 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13189 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013190 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13191 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013192
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013193ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13194 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013195 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13196 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13197 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013198 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13199
13200ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013201 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13202 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13203 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13204 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013205
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013206strict-sni
13207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13208 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13209 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13210 See the "crt" option for more information.
13211
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013212tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013213 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013214 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13215 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013216 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013217 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13218 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13219 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13220 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13221 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13222 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13223 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13224
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013225tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013226 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013227 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13228 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13229 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13230 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13231 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13232 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13233 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013234 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13235 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13236 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013237
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013238tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13239 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013240 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13241 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13242 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13243 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13244 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13245 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13246 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13247 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13248 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13249 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013250 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13251 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013253transparent
13254 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13255 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13256 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13257 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13258 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13259 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13260 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13261 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13262 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13263 so check for support with your vendor.
13264
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013265v4v6
13266 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13267 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13268 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13269 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013270 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013271
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013272v6only
13273 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13274 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13275 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013276 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13277 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013278
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013279uid <uid>
13280 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13281 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13282 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13283 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13284 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13285
13286user <user>
13287 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13288 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13289 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13290 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13291 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13292
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013293verify [none|optional|required]
13294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13295 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13296 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13297 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13298 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013299 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13300 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13301 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13302 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013303
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200133045.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013305------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013307The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13308which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13309arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13310settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13311after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13312Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13313address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013315 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013316 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013317
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013318Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13319keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013321The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013322
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013323addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013324 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013325 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13326 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13327 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13328 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13329 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013330
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013331agent-check
13332 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013333 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013334 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13335 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13336 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013338 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013339 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013340 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13341 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13342 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013344 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13345 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13346 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13347 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13348 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013350 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013351 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013352
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013353 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13354 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13355 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013356
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013357 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13358 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13359 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013360
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013361 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013362 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13363 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13364 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13365 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013366 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013367 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013368
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013369 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13370 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013371
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013372 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13373 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13374 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13375 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13376 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13377 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13378 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13379 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13380 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013381
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013382 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13383 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013384 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13385 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13386 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013387 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013388
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013389 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013390 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013391
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013392agent-send <string>
13393 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13394 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13395 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13396 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13397 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13398
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013399agent-inter <delay>
13400 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13401 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13402
13403 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13404 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13405 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13406 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13407 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13408 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13409 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13410 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13411 of backends use the same servers.
13412
13413 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13414
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013415agent-addr <addr>
13416 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13417
13418 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13419 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13420 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13421 hostname, it will be resolved.
13422
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013423agent-port <port>
13424 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13425
13426 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13427
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013428allow-0rtt
13429 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013430 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13431 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013432
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013433alpn <protocols>
13434 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13435 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13436 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013437 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013438 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13439 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13440 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13441 now obsolete NPN extension.
13442 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13443 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13444
13445 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013447backup
13448 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13449 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13450 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13451 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013452 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13453 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013454
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013455ca-file <cafile>
13456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13457 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13458 server's certificate.
13459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013460check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013461 This option enables health checks on a server:
13462 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13463 considered available.
13464 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13465 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13466 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13467 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13468 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13469 set.
13470 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13471 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13472 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13473 exchanges succeed.
13474
13475 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13476 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13477 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13478 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13479 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013480 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013481 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13482
13483 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13484 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13485
13486 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13487 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13488
13489 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13490 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13491 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13492 available.
13493
13494 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13495 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13496 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13497
13498 Example:
13499 # simple tcp check
13500 backend foo
13501 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13502 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13503 backend foo
13504 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13505 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13506 backend foo
13507 option tcp-check
13508 tcp-check connect
13509 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013510
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013511check-send-proxy
13512 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13513 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13514 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13515 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13516 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13517 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13518 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13519
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013520check-alpn <protocols>
13521 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13522 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13523 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13524
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013525check-proto <name>
13526 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13527 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13528 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13529 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013530 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013531 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13532 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13533
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013534check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013535 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013536 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13537 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013538
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013539check-ssl
13540 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13541 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13542 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13543 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013544 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013545 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13546 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013547 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013548 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13549 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013550
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013551check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013552 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013553 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13554 for normal traffic.
13555
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013556ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13558 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13559 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013560 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13561 information and recommendations see e.g.
13562 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13563 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13564 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013565
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013566ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13568 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13569 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13570 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013571 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13572 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13573 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013575cookie <value>
13576 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13577 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13578 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13579 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13580 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13581 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13582 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13583
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013584crl-file <crlfile>
13585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13586 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13587 to verify server's certificate.
13588
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013589crt <cert>
13590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13591 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13592 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13593 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13594 certificate request.
13595
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013596disabled
13597 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13598 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13599 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13600 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13601 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013602 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013603
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013604enabled
13605 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13606 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13607 default value.
13608 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13609 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013611error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013612 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13613 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13614 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013616 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013618fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013619 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13620 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13621 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13622
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013623force-sslv3
13624 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13625 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013626 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013627 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013628
13629force-tlsv10
13630 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013631 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013632 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013633
13634force-tlsv11
13635 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013636 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013637 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013638
13639force-tlsv12
13640 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013641 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013642 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013643
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013644force-tlsv13
13645 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13646 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013647 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013649id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013650 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13651 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13652 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013653
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013654init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13655 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13656 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013658 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13659 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13660 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13661 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13662 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13663 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13664 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13665 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13666 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013667 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013668 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13669 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13670 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13671 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13672 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13673 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013674 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013675
13676 Example:
13677 defaults
13678 # never fail on address resolution
13679 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013681inter <delay>
13682fastinter <delay>
13683downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013684 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13685 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13686 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13687 between checks depending on the server state :
13688
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013689 Server state | Interval used
13690 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13691 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13692 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13693 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13694 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13695 or yet unchecked. |
13696 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13697 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13698 | "inter" otherwise.
13699 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013701 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13702 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13703 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13704 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013705 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13706 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13707 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13708 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13709 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013710
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013711log-proto <logproto>
13712 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13713 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13714 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13715 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013717maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013718 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13719 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013720 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13721 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013722 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13723 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13724 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13725 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13726
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013727 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13728 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13729 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13730 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13731 than 50 concurrent requests.
13732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013733maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013734 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13735 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13736 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13737 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013738 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13739 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13740 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13741 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13742 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13743 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13744 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013745
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013746max-reuse <count>
13747 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13748 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13749 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13750 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13751 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13752 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13753 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13754 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013756minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013757 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13758 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13759 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13760 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13761 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13762 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013763 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013764 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013765
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013766namespace <name>
13767 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13768 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13769 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13770 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13771
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013772no-agent-check
13773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13775 default value.
13776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13777 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13778
13779no-backup
13780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13782 default value.
13783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13784 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13785
13786no-check
13787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13789 default value.
13790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13791 "default-server" "check" setting.
13792
13793no-check-ssl
13794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13796 default value.
13797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13798 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13799
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013800no-send-proxy
13801 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13802 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13803 default value.
13804 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13805 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13806
13807no-send-proxy-v2
13808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13810 default value.
13811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13812 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13813
13814no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13817 default value.
13818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13819 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13820
13821no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13824 default value.
13825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13826 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13827
13828no-ssl
13829 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13830 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13831 default value.
13832 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13833 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13834
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013835no-ssl-reuse
13836 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13837 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13838 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13839 and for paranoid users.
13840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013841no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013842 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13843 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013844 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013845
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013846 Supported in default-server: No
13847
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013848no-tls-tickets
13849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13850 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13851 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013852 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13853 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013854 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13855 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13856 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013857 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013858
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013859no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013860 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013861 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13862 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013863 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13864 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013865 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013866
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013867 Supported in default-server: No
13868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013869no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013870 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013871 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13872 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013873 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13874 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013875 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013876
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013877 Supported in default-server: No
13878
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013879no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013880 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013881 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13882 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013883 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13884 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013885 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013886
13887 Supported in default-server: No
13888
13889no-tlsv13
13890 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13891 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13892 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13893 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13894 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013895 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013896
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013897 Supported in default-server: No
13898
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013899no-verifyhost
13900 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13901 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13902 default value.
13903 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13904 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013905
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013906no-tfo
13907 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13908 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13909 default value.
13910 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13911 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13912
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013913non-stick
13914 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13915 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13916 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13917
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013918npn <protocols>
13919 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13920 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13921 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013922 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013923 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13924 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13925 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013927observe <mode>
13928 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13929 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13930 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13931 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13932 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13933 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013934 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013935
13936 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013938on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013939 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13940 Currently, four modes are available:
13941 - fastinter: force fastinter
13942 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13943 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13944 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13945 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13946
13947 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13948
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013949on-marked-down <action>
13950 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13951 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013952 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13953 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13954 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13955 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13956 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13957 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13958 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13959 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013960
13961 Actions are disabled by default
13962
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013963on-marked-up <action>
13964 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13965 Currently one action is available:
13966 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13967 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13968 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13969 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013970 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13971 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013972 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13973 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13974
13975 Actions are disabled by default
13976
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013977pool-low-conn <max>
13978 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13979 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13980 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13981 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13982 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13983 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13984 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13985 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13986 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13987 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau37e07892021-02-19 11:45:22 +010013988 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
13989 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
13990 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
13991 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013992
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013993pool-max-conn <max>
13994 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13995 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13996 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13997 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13998 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13999 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14000
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014001pool-purge-delay <delay>
14002 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014003 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014004 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014006port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014007 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
14008 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
14009 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
14010 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
14011 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
14012 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
14013
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014014proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014015 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14016 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14017 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14018 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014019 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014020 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014022redir <prefix>
14023 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14024 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14025 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14026 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14027 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14028 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14029 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14030 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014031 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014032 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014033 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14034 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14035 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14036 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14037
14038 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014040rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014041 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14042 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14043 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14044
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014045resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14046 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14047 server.
14048
14049 Available options:
14050
14051 * allow-dup-ip
14052 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14053 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14054 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14055 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14056 For such case, simply enable this option.
14057 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14058
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014059 * ignore-weight
14060 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14061 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14062 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14063
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014064 * prevent-dup-ip
14065 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14066 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14067 same fqdn.
14068 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14069
14070 Example:
14071 backend b_myapp
14072 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14073 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14074 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14075
14076 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14077 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14078 it
14079 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14080 different address
14081
14082 Default value: not set
14083
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014084resolve-prefer <family>
14085 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14086 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14087 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14088 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14089
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014090 Default value: ipv6
14091
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014092 Example:
14093
14094 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014095
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014096resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014097 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014098 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014099 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14101 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014102 configured network, another address is selected.
14103
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014104 Example:
14105
14106 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014107
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014108resolvers <id>
14109 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14110 hostname.
14111
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014112 Example:
14113
14114 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014115
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014116 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014117
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014118send-proxy
14119 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14120 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14121 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14122 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014123 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14124 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14125 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14126 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14127 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14128 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14129 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14130 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14131 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14132 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014133 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14134 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014135
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014136send-proxy-v2
14137 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14138 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14139 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14140 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014141 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14142 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14143 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14144 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014145
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014146proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014147 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14148 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14149
14150 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14151 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14152 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14153 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14154 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14155 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14156 connection is supported).
14157 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14158 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14159 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14160 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14161 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14162 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14163 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014164
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014165send-proxy-v2-ssl
14166 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14167 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14168 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14169 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14170 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14171 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14172 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014173 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14174 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014175
14176send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14177 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14178 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14179 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14180 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14181 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14182 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14183 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14184 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014185 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14186 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014188slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014189 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14190 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14191 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14192 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14193 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14194 parameters :
14195
14196 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14197 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14198
14199 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14200 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14201 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14202 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14203
14204 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14205 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14206 seen as failed.
14207
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014208sni <expression>
14209 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14210 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14211 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14212 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014213 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14214 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014215 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014216 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14217 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014218
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014219source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014220source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014221source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014222 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14223 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14224 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14225 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14226
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014227 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14228 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14229 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14230 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14231 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14232 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14233 server.
14234
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014235 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14236 specifying the source address without port(s).
14237
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014238ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014239 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14240 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14241 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14242 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14243 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14244 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014245 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14246 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014247
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014248ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14249 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14250 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14252
14253ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14254 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14255 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14256 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14257
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014258ssl-reuse
14259 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14260 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14261 default value.
14262 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14263 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14264
14265stick
14266 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14267 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14268 default value.
14269 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14270 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014271
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014272socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014273 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014274 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14275 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14276
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014277tcp-ut <delay>
14278 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14279 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14280 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014281 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014282 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14283 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14284 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14285 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14286 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14287 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14288 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14289 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14290 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14291
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014292tfo
14293 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14294 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14295 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14296 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14297 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014298 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014300track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014301 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14302 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14303 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14304 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014305 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14306
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014307tls-tickets
14308 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14309 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14310 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014311 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14312 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14313 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014314 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014315 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014316
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014317verify [none|required]
14318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014319 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014320 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14321 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014322 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014323 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14324 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14325 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14326 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14327 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14328 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14329 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14330 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014331
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014332verifyhost <hostname>
14333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014334 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14335 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14336 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14337 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14338 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14339 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14340 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14341 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014343weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014344 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14345 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14346 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014347 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14348 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14349 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14350 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14351 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14352 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353
14354
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143555.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14356-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014357
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014358HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14359using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014360configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014361This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14362can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14363workload.
14364This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14365resolution at run time.
14366Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14367carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14368
14369
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143705.3.1. Global overview
14371----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014372
14373As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14374different steps of the process life:
14375
14376 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14377 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14378 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14379
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014380 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14381 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014382
14383A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14384 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14385 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14386 resolution to know this new IP.
14387
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014388When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014390SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14391from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14392will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14393will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014394
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014395A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014396 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014397 first valid response.
14398
14399 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14400 servers return an error.
14401
14402
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144035.3.2. The resolvers section
14404----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014405
14406This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014407HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14408contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014409
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014410When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14411uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14412is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14413answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14414
14415When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014416used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014417
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014418 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14419 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14420 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014421
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014422 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14423 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014424
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014425 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14426 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14427 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014428
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014429For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14430following scenarios are possible:
14431
14432 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14433 ignored
14434
14435 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14436 applied
14437
14438 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14439 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14440
14441 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14442 retries the query with a new type
14443
14444 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14445 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014446
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014447As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14448a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014449<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014450
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014451
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014452resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014453 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014454
14455A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14456
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014457accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014458 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014459 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014460 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14461 by RFC 6891)
14462
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014463 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14464
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014465nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14466 DNS server description:
14467 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14468 <ip> : IP address of the server
14469 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14470
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014471parse-resolv-conf
14472 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14473 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14474 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14475
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014476hold <status> <period>
14477 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14478 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014479 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014480 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014481 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14482 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14483 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14484
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014485 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014486
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014487resolve_retries <nb>
14488 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14489 giving up.
14490 Default value: 3
14491
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014492 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14493 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14494 type.
14495
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014496timeout <event> <time>
14497 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14498 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14499 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014500 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14501 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014502 Default value: 1s
14503 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014504 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014505 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014506 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14507 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14508
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014509 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014510
14511 resolvers mydns
14512 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14513 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014514 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014515 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014516 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014517 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014518 hold other 30s
14519 hold refused 30s
14520 hold nx 30s
14521 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014522 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014523 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014524
14525
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145266. Cache
14527---------
14528
14529HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14530(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14531RAM.
14532
14533The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14534this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14535
14536If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14537independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14538when we try to allocate a new one.
14539
14540The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14541
14542It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14543"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14544for more details.
14545
14546When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14547replaced by "<CACHE>".
14548
14549
145506.1. Limitation
14551----------------
14552
14553The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14554
14555- If the response is not a 200
14556- If the response contains a Vary header
14557- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14558- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonea8e0812020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014559- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14560 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14561 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014562
14563- If the request is not a GET
14564- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14565- If the request contains an Authorization header
14566
14567
145686.2. Setup
14569-----------
14570
14571To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14572the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14573
14574
145756.2.1. Cache section
14576---------------------
14577
14578cache <name>
14579 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14580 size of cache is mandatory.
14581
14582total-max-size <megabytes>
14583 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14584 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14585
14586max-object-size <bytes>
14587 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14588 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14589 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14590
14591max-age <seconds>
14592 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14593 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14594 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14595 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14596 default.
14597
14598
145996.2.2. Proxy section
14600---------------------
14601
14602http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14603 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14604 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14605 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14606 after this one.
14607
14608http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14609 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14610 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14611 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14612 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14613
14614
14615Example:
14616
14617 backend bck1
14618 mode http
14619
14620 http-request cache-use foobar
14621 http-response cache-store foobar
14622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14623
14624 cache foobar
14625 total-max-size 4
14626 max-age 240
14627
14628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146297. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14630----------------------------------
14631
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014632HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14634The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14635these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14636but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14637data called patterns.
14638
14639
146407.1. ACL basics
14641---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014642
14643The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14644content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14645from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14646simple :
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014649 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14651 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14654adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014655
14656In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014659
14660This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14661Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14662and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014663an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14664conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14665as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14666are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014667
14668ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14669'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14670which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14671
14672There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14673performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14676specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14677this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014678methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14679ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680
14681Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14682 - boolean
14683 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14684 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14685 - string
14686 - data block
14687
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014688Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14689converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14690would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14691The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14692which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14693
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014694Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14695keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14696fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14697which are summarized in the table below :
14698
14699 +---------------------+-----------------+
14700 | Sample or converter | Default |
14701 | output type | matching method |
14702 +---------------------+-----------------+
14703 | boolean | bool |
14704 +---------------------+-----------------+
14705 | integer | int |
14706 +---------------------+-----------------+
14707 | ip | ip |
14708 +---------------------+-----------------+
14709 | string | str |
14710 +---------------------+-----------------+
14711 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14712 +---------------------+-----------------+
14713
14714Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14715matching method, see below.
14716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14718 - boolean
14719 - integer or integer range
14720 - IP address / network
14721 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14722 - regular expression
14723 - hex block
14724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014725The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14726
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014727 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14728 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014730 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014731 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014732 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014733 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14736read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14737if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14738lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14739will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14740beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14741a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14742lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14743exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14744
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014745The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14746parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14747ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14748a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14749check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14750
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014751The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14752socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14753file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14756loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14757
14758 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14759
14760In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14761the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14762case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14763as well.
14764
14765The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14766sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14767do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14768methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14769is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014770obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14772default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14773that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14774string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14775
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014776The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14777By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14778string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14779resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14780server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014781waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014782flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14783function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14786sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14787be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014788
14789 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14790 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14792 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14793 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14794 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014795
14796 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14797 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014799
14800 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014802
14803 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014806 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014807 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14808
14809 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14810 binary or string samples.
14811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14813 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14816 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14817 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14820 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14823 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14826 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14829 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014830 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14833 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14834 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014835
14836For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14837request, it is possible to do :
14838
14839 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14840
14841In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14842buffer, one would use the following acl :
14843
14844 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14845
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014846On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14847possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14848
14849 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014851All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14852criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14853method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14854to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14855criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14856the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014859the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14860For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14863 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14864 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14865 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014866
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014867
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014868The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14869types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14870combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14871brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14872default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 +-------------------------------------------------+
14875 | Input sample type |
14876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014877 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14879 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014881 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014883 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014885 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014887 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014889 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014891 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014893 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014895 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014897 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014899 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014901 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14903 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014905
14906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149077.1.1. Matching booleans
14908------------------------
14909
14910In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14911Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14912When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14913that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14914
14915Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14916return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14917"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149207.1.2. Matching integers
14921------------------------
14922
14923Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14924enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14925to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14926
14927Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14928matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14929lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014930
14931For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14932unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14933representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14934
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014935As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14936two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14937instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14938ranges and operators.
14939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014940For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014941operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14942Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14943of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014945Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014946
14947 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14948 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14949 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14950 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14951 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014953For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014954
14955 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14956
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014957This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14958
14959 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14960
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149627.1.3. Matching strings
14963-----------------------
14964
14965String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14966different forms :
14967
14968 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970
14971 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014972 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973
14974 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14975 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14976
14977 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14978 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14979
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014980 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14982 matches.
14983
14984 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14985 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14986 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014987
14988String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14989exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14990characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14991string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14992to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014993before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014994
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014995Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14996(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14997Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14998
14999Example:
15000 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15001 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150047.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15005---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015006
15007Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15008they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15009possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15010passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15011the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015012the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15013match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015014
15015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150167.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15017-------------------------------------
15018
15019It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15020not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15021a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15022to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15023digits may be used upper or lower case.
15024
15025Example :
15026 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15027 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15028
15029
150307.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15031---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015032
15033IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15034netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15035within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015036host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015037difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15038at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15039does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15040parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015041
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015042The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15043abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15044
15045 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15046 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15047 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15048 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15049 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15050 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15051 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15052 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15053
15054Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15055192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15056
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015057IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15058Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15059trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15060IPv6 patterns.
15061
15062HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15063following situations :
15064 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15065 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15066 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15067 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15068 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15069 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15070 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15071 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15072 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15073 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075
150767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15077----------------------------------
15078
15079Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15080combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15081
15082 - AND (implicit)
15083 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15084 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15091indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15094"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15095requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15096is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15097
15098 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015099 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15100 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15101 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102
15103To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15104and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15105
15106 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15107 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15108 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15109 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015111 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15113 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15114 use_backend www if host_www
15115
15116It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15117expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15118be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15119the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15120
15121 The following rule :
15122
15123 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015124 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125
15126 Can also be written that way :
15127
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015128 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129
15130It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15131to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15132simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15133sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15134good use is the following :
15135
15136 With named ACLs :
15137
15138 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15139 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15140 monitor fail if site_dead
15141
15142 With anonymous ACLs :
15143
15144 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15145
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015146See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15147keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148
15149
151507.3. Fetching samples
15151---------------------
15152
15153Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15154against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15155sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15156ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15157of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15158available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15159
15160This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15161Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15162compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15163deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15164
15165The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15166matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15167method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15168indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15169
15170As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15171when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15172mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15173the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15174ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15175
15176Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15177multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15178when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15180are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15182all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15183
15184Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15185 - name
15186 - name(arg1)
15187 - name(arg1,arg2)
15188
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015189
151907.3.1. Converters
15191-----------------
15192
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015193Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15194of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15195is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15196was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015197has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015198unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15199
15200These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15201sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15202the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015204
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015205A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15206support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15207supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15208(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15209bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015212
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001521351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15214 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15215 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15216 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15217 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15218 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15219
15220 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015221 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15222 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015223 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15224 frontend http-in
15225 bind *:8081
15226 default_backend servers
15227 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15228 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15229
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015230add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015231 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015232 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015233 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15234 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015235 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015236 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15237 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015242
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015243aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15244 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15245 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15246 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15247 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15248 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15249 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15250
15251 Example:
15252 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15253 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15254
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015255and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015256 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015257 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015258 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15259 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15264 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015266 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015267
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015268b64dec
15269 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15270 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15271
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015272base64
15273 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015274 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015275 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015277bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015278 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015279 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015280 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015281 presence of a flag).
15282
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015283bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15284 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15285 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015286 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015287
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015288concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15289 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15290 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15291 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15292 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15293 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15294 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15295 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15296 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15297 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15298 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015299 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015300 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015301 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15302 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015303
15304 Example:
15305 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15306 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15307 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015308 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015309 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015311cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015312 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15313 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015314
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015315crc32([<avalanche>])
15316 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15317 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15318 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15319 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15320 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15321 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15322 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15323 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15324 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15325 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015326 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15327
15328crc32c([<avalanche>])
15329 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15330 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15331 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15332 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15333 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15334 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15335 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15336 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015337
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015338cut_crlf
15339 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15340 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15341 updated.
15342
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015343da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015344 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15345 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15346 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15347 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015348 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015349 configuration language.
15350
15351 Example:
15352 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015353 bind *:8881
15354 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015355 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015356
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015357debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15358 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15359 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15360 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15361 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15362 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15363 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15364 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15365 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15366 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15367 printable sample types.
15368
15369 Example:
15370 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015371
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015372digest(<algorithm>)
15373 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15374 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15375
15376 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15377 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15378
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015379div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015380 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15381 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015382 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015383 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15384 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015385 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015386 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15387 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15388 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15389 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015391 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015392
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015393djb2([<avalanche>])
15394 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15395 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15396 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15397 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15398 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15399 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15400 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015401 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15402 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015403
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015404even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015405 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015406 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15407
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015408field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15409 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15410 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15411 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15412 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15413 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15414 fields.
15415
15416 Example :
15417 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15418 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15419 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15420 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15421 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015423hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015424 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015425 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015426 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015427 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015428
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015429hex2i
15430 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015431 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015432
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015433htonl
15434 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15435 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15436 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15437 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15438
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015439hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15440 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15441 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15442 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15443 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15444
15445 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15446 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15447
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015448http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015449 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15450 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015451 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15452 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15453 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15454 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15455 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15456 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15457 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15458 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015460iif(<true>,<false>)
15461 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15462 string otherwise.
15463
15464 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015465 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015466
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015467in_table(<table>)
15468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15470 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015471 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015472 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15473
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015474ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15475 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015476 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015477 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15478 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15479 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15480 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15481 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015482
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015483json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015484 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015485 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015486 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015487 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15488 of errors:
15489 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15490 bytes, ...)
15491 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15492 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15493
15494 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15495 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15496 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15497 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15498 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15499 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015500 - "ascii" : never fails;
15501 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15502 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015503 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015504 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015505 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15506 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15507
15508 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015509 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015510
15511 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015512 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015513 capture request header user-agent len 150
15514 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015515
15516 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15517 GET / HTTP/1.0
15518 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15519
15520 Output log:
15521 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15522
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015523language(<value>[,<default>])
15524 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15525 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15526 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15527 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15528 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15529 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15530 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15531 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15532 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015533 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015534 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15535 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015536
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015537 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015539 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15540 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015542 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15543 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15544 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15545 use_backend spanish if es
15546 use_backend french if fr
15547 use_backend english if en
15548 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015549
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015550length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015551 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15552 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15553 type. The result is of type integer.
15554
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015555lower
15556 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15557 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15558 type. The result is of type string.
15559
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015560ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15561 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15562 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15563 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15564 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15565 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15566 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15567
15568 Example :
15569
15570 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015571 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015572 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15573
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015574ltrim(<chars>)
15575 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15576 representation of the input sample.
15577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015578map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15579map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15580map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15581 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15582 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15583 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15584 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15585 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15586 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15587 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15588 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015590 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15591 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15592 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015593
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015594 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015595 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015597 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15599 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015601 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015603 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15605 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15607 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15609 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015611 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15613 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015614 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15615 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15616 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15617 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015619
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015620 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15621 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15622 the corresponding match text.
15623
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015624 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15625 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15626 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15627 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15628 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015630 Example :
15631
15632 # this is a comment and is ignored
15633 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15634 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15635 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15636 | | | `---------- value
15637 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15638 | `---------------------------- key
15639 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15640
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015641mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015642 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15643 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015644 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015645 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015646 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015647 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15648 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15649 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15650 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015651 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015652 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015653
15654mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015655 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015656 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15657 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015658 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015659 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015660 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015661 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15662 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15663 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15664 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015666 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015667
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015668nbsrv
15669 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15670 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15671 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15672 map lookup.
15673
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015674neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015675 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15676 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15677 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15678 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015679
15680not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015681 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015682 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015684 absence of a flag).
15685
15686odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015687 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015688 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15689
15690or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015691 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015692 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015693 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15694 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015702
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015703protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15704 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15705 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15706 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15707 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15708 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15709 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15710 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15711 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15712 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15713 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15714 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15715
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015716regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015717 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15718 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15719 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15720 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15721 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15722 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15723 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15724 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15725 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015726 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15727 of characters with other ones.
15728
15729 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15730 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15731 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15732 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15733 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15734 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015735
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015736 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015737
15738 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15739 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15740 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015741 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015742
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015743 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15744 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15745
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015746 # capture groups and backreferences
15747 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015748 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015749 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15750
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015751capture-req(<id>)
15752 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15753 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15754
15755 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015756 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15757 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015758
15759capture-res(<id>)
15760 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15761 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15762
15763 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015764 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15765 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015766
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015767rtrim(<chars>)
15768 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15769 of the input sample.
15770
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015771sdbm([<avalanche>])
15772 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15773 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15774 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15775 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15776 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15777 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15778 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015779 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15780 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015781
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015782secure_memcmp(<var>)
15783 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15784 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15785 match.
15786
15787 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15788 performed in constant time.
15789
15790 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15791 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15792
15793 Example :
15794
15795 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15796 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15797 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15798 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15799
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015800set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015801 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15802 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15803 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015804 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015805 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15806 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015807 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015808 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15809 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015810 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015811 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015812
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015813sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015814 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015815 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15816
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015817sha2([<bits>])
15818 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15819 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15820
15821 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15822 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15823
15824 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15825 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15826
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015827srv_queue
15828 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15829 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15830 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15831 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15832 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15833
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015834strcmp(<var>)
15835 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15836 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15837 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15838 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15839 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15840 shorter).
15841
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015842 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15843 strings in constant time.
15844
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015845 Example :
15846
15847 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15848 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15849 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15850
15851
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015852sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015853 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15854 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015855 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015856 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15857 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015858 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015859 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15860 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015861 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015862 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15863 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015864 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015865 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015866
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015867table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15871 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15872 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15873 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15874
15875
15876table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15877 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15878 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15879 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15880 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15881 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15882 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15883
15884table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015887 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015888 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15889 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15890
15891table_conn_cur(<table>)
15892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15895 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15896 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15897
15898table_conn_rate(<table>)
15899 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15900 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15901 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15902 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15903 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15904
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015905table_gpt0(<table>)
15906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15909 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15910 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15911
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015912table_gpc0(<table>)
15913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15916 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15917 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15918
15919table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15923 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15924 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15925 sample fetch keyword.
15926
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015927table_gpc1(<table>)
15928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15931 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15932 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15933
15934table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15937 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15938 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15939 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15940 sample fetch keyword.
15941
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015942table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015946 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15947 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15948
15949table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15952 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15953 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15954 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15955 keyword.
15956
15957table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15958 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15959 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015961 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15962 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15963
15964table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15967 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15968 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15969 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15970 keyword.
15971
15972table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015975 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015976 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15977 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15978 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15979 keyword.
15980
15981table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015985 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15986 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15987 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15988 keyword.
15989
15990table_server_id(<table>)
15991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15994 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15995 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15996 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15997
15998table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016002 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16003 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16004 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16005 keyword.
16006
16007table_sess_rate(<table>)
16008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16011 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16012 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16013 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16014 keyword.
16015
16016table_trackers(<table>)
16017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16020 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16021 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16022 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16023 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16024 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16025 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16026 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16027
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016028upper
16029 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16030 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16031 type. The result is of type string.
16032
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016033url_dec([<in_form>])
16034 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16035 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16036 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16037 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16038 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16039 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016040
William Dauchy55ed7c42021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016041url_enc([<enc_type>])
16042 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16043 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16044 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16045 optional argument is here for future changes.
16046
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016047ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016048 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016049 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16050 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16051 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016052 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16053 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16054 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16055 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016056 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016057 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16058 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016059
16060 Example:
16061 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16062 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16063
16064 message Point {
16065 int32 latitude = 1;
16066 int32 longitude = 2;
16067 }
16068
16069 message PPoint {
16070 Point point = 59;
16071 }
16072
16073 message Rectangle {
16074 // One corner of the rectangle.
16075 PPoint lo = 48;
16076 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16077 PPoint hi = 49;
16078 }
16079
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016080 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16081 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16082 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016083
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016084 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16085 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016086 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016087 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16088
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016089 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016090
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016091 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016092
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016093 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16094 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16095 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016096
16097 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16098 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16099 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16100
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016101 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16102 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16103 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016104
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016105
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016106unset-var(<var name>)
16107 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16108 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16109 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16110 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16111 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16112 response),
16113 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16114 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16115 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16116 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16117
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016118utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16119 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16120 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16121 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16122 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16123 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16124 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16125
16126 Example :
16127
16128 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016129 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016130 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16131
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016132word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16133 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16134 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16135 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016136 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016137 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16138 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16139
16140 Example :
16141 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16142 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16143 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16144 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016146 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016147
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016148wt6([<avalanche>])
16149 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16150 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16151 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16152 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16153 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16154 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16155 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016156 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16157 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016158
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016159xor(<value>)
16160 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016161 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016162 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016163 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016164 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016165 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16166 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016167 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016168 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16169 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016170 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016171 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016172
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016173xxh32([<seed>])
16174 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16175 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16176 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16177 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16178 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16179 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16180 as cryptographically secure.
16181
16182xxh64([<seed>])
16183 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16184 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16185 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16186 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16187 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16188 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16189 as cryptographically secure.
16190
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161927.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193--------------------------------------------
16194
16195A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16196not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16197"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16198The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16199
16200always_false : boolean
16201 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16202 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16203
16204always_true : boolean
16205 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16206 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16207
16208avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016209 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16211 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16212 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16213 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16214 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16215 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16216 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16217 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16218 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16219 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16220 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16221 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16222 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016225 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16226 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16227 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16228 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016229 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16230
16231be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16233 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16234 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16235 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16236 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016237 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16238 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016239
16240 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16241 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16242 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16246 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16247 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16250 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016251
16252 Example :
16253 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16254 backend dynamic
16255 mode http
16256 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16257 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016258
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016259bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016260 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16261 of the string.
16262
16263bool(<bool>) : bool
16264 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16265 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016269 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16271 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016272
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016273 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016274 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016275 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16276
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016277 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16278 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016279
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016280 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016281 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016283 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016286 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016287
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016288 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16289 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016290 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016291 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016292
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016293cpu_calls : integer
16294 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16295 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16296 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16297 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16298 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16299 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16300
16301cpu_ns_avg : integer
16302 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16303 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16304 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16305 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16306 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16307 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16308 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16309 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16310 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16311 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16312 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16313
16314cpu_ns_tot : integer
16315 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16316 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16317 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16318 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16319 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16320 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16321 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16322 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16323 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16324 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16325 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16326 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16327 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16328
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016329date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016330 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016331
16332 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16333 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16334 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016335 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16336
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016337 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16338 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16339 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16340 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16341 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16342
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016343 Example :
16344
16345 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16346 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016347
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016348 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16349 # millisecond granularity
16350 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16351
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016352date_us : integer
16353 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16354 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16355 from the same timeval structure.
16356
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016357distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16358 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16359 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16360 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16361 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16362 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16363 list of supported tokens.
16364
16365distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16366 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16367 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16368 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16369 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16370 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16371 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16372 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16373 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16374 supported tokens.
16375
16376 Example :
16377 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16378 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16379 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16380 # send large files to the big farm
16381 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16382
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016383env(<name>) : string
16384 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16385 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16386 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16387 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16388 certain way.
16389
16390 Examples :
16391 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16392 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16393
16394 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16395 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16398 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016399 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16400 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16402 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016403 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16405 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016406
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016407fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16409 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16410 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16413 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16414 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16415 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16416 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16417 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16418 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16419 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16420 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016421
16422 Example :
16423 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16424 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16425 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16426 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16427 frontend mail
16428 bind :25
16429 mode tcp
16430 maxconn 100
16431 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16432 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16433 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16434 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016435
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016436hostname : string
16437 Returns the system hostname.
16438
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016439int(<integer>) : signed integer
16440 Returns a signed integer.
16441
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016442ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16443 Returns an ipv4.
16444
16445ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16446 Returns an ipv6.
16447
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016448lat_ns_avg : integer
16449 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16450 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16451 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16452 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16453 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16454 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16455 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16456 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16457 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016458 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16459 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16460 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16461 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16462 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16463 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016464
16465lat_ns_tot : integer
16466 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16467 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16468 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16469 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16470 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16471 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16472 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16473 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16474 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016475 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16476 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16477 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16478 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16479 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016480 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16481 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16482 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16483 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16484 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16485 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16486
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016487meth(<method>) : method
16488 Returns a method.
16489
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016490nbproc : integer
16491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16492 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16493 and debugging purposes.
16494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016495nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16497 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16498 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016499 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16500 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16501 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016502
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016503prio_class : integer
16504 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16505 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16506 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16507
16508prio_offset : integer
16509 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16510 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16511 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16512 set-priority-offset".
16513
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016514proc : integer
16515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16516 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16517 debugging purposes.
16518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016519queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016520 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16521 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16522 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16524 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16525 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16526 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16527 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16528
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016529rand([<range>]) : integer
16530 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16531 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16532 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16533 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16534 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16538 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16539 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16540 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16541 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016542 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16543 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16544
16545srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16546 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16547 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16548 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16549 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16550 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16551 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16552 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16553
16554 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16555 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016556
16557srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16558 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16559 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16560 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16563 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16564 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16565
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016566srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16568 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16569 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16570 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16571 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16572 fetch methods.
16573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016574srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16575 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16576 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016577 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16579 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016580 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016581 overloading servers).
16582
16583 Example :
16584 # Redirect to a separate back
16585 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16586 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16587 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16588
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016589srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16590 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16591 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16592 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16593
16594srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16595 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16596 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16597 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16598
16599srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16600 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16601 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16602 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16603
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016604stopping : boolean
16605 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16606 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16607 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16608
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016609str(<string>) : string
16610 Returns a string.
16611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016612table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16613 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16614 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16615
16616table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16617 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16618 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16619 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16620
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016621thread : integer
16622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16623 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16624 and debugging purposes.
16625
Alexandar Lazic6f273212021-06-01 00:27:01 +020016626uuid([<version>]) : string
16627 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16628 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16629 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16630
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016631var(<var-name>) : undefined
16632 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016633 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16634 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016635 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016636 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16637 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016638 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016639 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16640 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016641 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016642 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166447.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016645----------------------------------
16646
16647The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16648closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16649methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16650sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16651TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016652the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16653counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016654"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16655used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16656can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16657Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16658table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16659tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16660currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016662bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016663 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16664 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16665 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016667be_id : integer
16668 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016669 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16670 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016672be_name : string
16673 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016674 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16675 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677dst : ip
16678 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16679 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16680 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16681 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016682 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16683 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16684 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16685 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16686 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16687 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016688
16689dst_conn : integer
16690 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16691 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16692 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16693 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16694 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16695 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16696 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16697 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016698
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016699dst_is_local : boolean
16700 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16701 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16702 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16703 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016704 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016705 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16706 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16707 it only once per connection.
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709dst_port : integer
16710 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16711 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16712 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16713 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16714 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16715 an HTTP header.
16716
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016717fc_http_major : integer
16718 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16719 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16720 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16721
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016722fc_pp_authority : string
16723 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16724 if any.
16725
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016726fc_pp_unique_id : string
16727 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16728 if any.
16729
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016730fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16731 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16732 header.
16733
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016734fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16735 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16736 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16737 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16738 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16739 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16740 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16741
16742fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16743 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16744 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16745 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16746 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16747 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16748 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16749
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016750fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016751 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16752 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16753 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16754 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16755
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016756fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016757 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16758 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16759 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16760 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16761
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016762fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016763 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16764 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16765 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16766 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16767
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016768fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016769 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16770 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16771 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16772 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16773
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016774fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016775 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16776 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16777 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16778 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16779
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016780fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016781 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16782 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16783 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16784 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16785
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016786fe_defbe : string
16787 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16788 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790fe_id : integer
16791 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016792 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16794
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016795fe_name : string
16796 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16797 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16798 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016800sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016801sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16802sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16803sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016804 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16805 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16806 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016808sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016809sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16810sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16811sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016812 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16813 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16814 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016816sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016817sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16818sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16819sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016820 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16821 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016822 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16823 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16824 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016825
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016826 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016827 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16828 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016829 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16830 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16831 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016832 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16833 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16834
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016835sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16836sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16837sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16838sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16839 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16840 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16841 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16842 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16843 when a first ACL was verified.
16844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016845sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016846sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16847sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16848sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016849 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016850 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016852sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016853sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16854sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16855sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016856 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16857 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16858 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016860sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016861sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16862sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16863sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016864 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16865 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16866 See also src_conn_rate.
16867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016868sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016869sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16870sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16871sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016872 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016873 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016874
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016875sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16876sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16877sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16878sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16879 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16880 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16881
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016882sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16883sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16884sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16885sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16886 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16887 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16888
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016889sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016890sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16891sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16892sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016893 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16894 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16895 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016896 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16897 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16898 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016899
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016900sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16901sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16902sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16903sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16904 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16905 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16906 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16907 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16908 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16909 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016911sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016912sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16913sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16914sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016915 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016916 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16917 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016919sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016920sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16921sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16922sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016923 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16924 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16925 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16926 src_http_err_rate.
16927
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016928sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016929sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16930sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16931sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016932 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016933 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16934 src_http_req_cnt.
16935
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016936sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016937sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16938sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16939sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016940 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16941 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16942 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16943 src_http_req_rate.
16944
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016945sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016946sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16947sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16948sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016949 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016950 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16951 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16952 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16953 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016954
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016955 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016956 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16957 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016958 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16959
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016960sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16961sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16962sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16963sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16964 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16965 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16966 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16967 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16968 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016970sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016971sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16972sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16973sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016974 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16975 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16976 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016977
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016978sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016979sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16980sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16981sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016982 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16983 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16984 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016986sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016987sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16988sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16989sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016990 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016991 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16992 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16993 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016994 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016995 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016997sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016998sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16999sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17000sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017001 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17002 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17003 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17004 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17005 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017006 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017007
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017008sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017009sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17010sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17011sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017012 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17013 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17014 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17015
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017016sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017017sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17018sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17019sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017020 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17021 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017022 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017023 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17024 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017025 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17026 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17027 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029so_id : integer
17030 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17031 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17032 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017033
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017034so_name : string
17035 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17036 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17037 strings instead of integers.
17038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017039src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017040 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17042 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17043 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017044 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17045 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17046 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017047 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17048 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17049 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17050 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17051 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17052 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17053 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017054
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017055 Example:
17056 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17057 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17060 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17061 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17062 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017063 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17066 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17067 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017068 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017069 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017071src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17072 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17073 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17074 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17075 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17076 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17077 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017078
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017079 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017080 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17081 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17082 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17083 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017084 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017085 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17086 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17087
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017088src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17089 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17090 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17091 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17092 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17093 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17094 was verified.
17095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017097 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017099 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017100 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017102src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017103 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017104 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17105 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017106 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17109 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17110 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17111 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017112 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017115 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017116 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017117 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017118 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017119
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017120src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17121 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17122 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17123 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17124 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17125
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017126src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17127 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17128 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17129 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17130 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017133 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017135 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17136 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017137 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17138 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17139 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017140
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017141src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17142 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17143 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17144 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17145 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17146 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17147 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17148 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017151 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017153 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017154 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017157src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17158 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17159 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17160 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17161 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017162 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017165 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17167 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017168 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017170src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17171 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17172 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17173 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017174 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017175 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017177src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17178 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17179 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17180 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017181 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017182 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17183 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017184
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017185 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017186 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017187 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017188 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017189
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017190src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17191 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17192 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17193 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17194 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17195 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17196 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17197
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017198src_is_local : boolean
17199 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17200 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17201 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17202 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017203 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017204 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17205 once per connection.
17206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017207src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017208 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17209 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17210 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17211 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17212 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017214src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017215 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17216 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17217 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17218 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17219 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017221src_port : integer
17222 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17223 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17224 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17225 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017228 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017229 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17230 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17231 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017232 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17235 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17236 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17237 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17238 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017239 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017241src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17242 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17243 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17244 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17245 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17246 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17247 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17248 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17249 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017250
17251 Example :
17252 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17253 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17254 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17255 listen ssh
17256 bind :22
17257 mode tcp
17258 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017259 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017261 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263srv_id : integer
17264 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17265 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017266 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017267
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017268srv_name : string
17269 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17270 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017271 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017272
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172737.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17277closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17278when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17279usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017280future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017281
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001728251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17283 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17284 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17285 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17286 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17287 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17288
17289 Example :
17290 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17291 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17292 # the request.
17293 frontend http-in
17294 bind *:8081
17295 default_backend servers
17296 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17297 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17298
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017299ssl_bc : boolean
17300 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17301 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017302 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17303 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017304
17305ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17306 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017307 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17308 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017309
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017310ssl_bc_alpn : string
17311 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17312 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017313 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017314 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17315 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17316 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17317 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17318 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017319 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17320 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017321
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017322ssl_bc_cipher : string
17323 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017324 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17325 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017326
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017327ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17328 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17329 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17330 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017331 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017332
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017333ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17334 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17335 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017336 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17337 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017338
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017339ssl_bc_npn : string
17340 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17341 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017342 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017343 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17344 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17345 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17346 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017347 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17348 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017349
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017350ssl_bc_protocol : string
17351 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017352 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17353 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017354
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017355ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017356 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017357 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017358 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17359 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017360
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017361ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17362 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17363 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17364 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017365 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017366
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017367ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17368 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17369 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017370 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17371 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017372
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017373ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17374 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17375 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17376 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017377 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017378
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017379ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17380 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017381 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17382 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17385 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17386 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17387 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17388 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17389 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17392 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17393 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17394 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17395 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017396
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017397ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017398 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17399 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17400 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17401 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17402 does not support resumed sessions.
17403
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017404ssl_c_der : binary
17405 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17406 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17407 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409ssl_c_err : integer
17410 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17411 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17412 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17413 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17414 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017415
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017416ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17418 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17419 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17420 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17421 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17422 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17423 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17424 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017425 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17426 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17427 LDAP v3.
17428 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17429 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431ssl_c_key_alg : string
17432 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17433 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17434 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436ssl_c_notafter : string
17437 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17438 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17439 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017441ssl_c_notbefore : string
17442 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17443 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17444 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017445
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017446ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017447 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17448 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17449 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17450 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17451 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17452 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17453 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17454 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017455 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17456 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17457 LDAP v3.
17458 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17459 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017461ssl_c_serial : binary
17462 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17463 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17464 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017466ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17467 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17468 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17469 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017470 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17471 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17472
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017473 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017474 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17477 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17478 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17479 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017481ssl_c_used : boolean
17482 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17483 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017485ssl_c_verify : integer
17486 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17487 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17488 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17489 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491ssl_c_version : integer
17492 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17493 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017494
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017495ssl_f_der : binary
17496 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17497 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17498 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17499
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017500ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017501 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17502 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17503 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17504 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017505 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17507 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17508 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017509 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17510 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17511 LDAP v3.
17512 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17513 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515ssl_f_key_alg : string
17516 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17517 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17518 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520ssl_f_notafter : string
17521 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17522 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17523 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017525ssl_f_notbefore : string
17526 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17527 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17528 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017529
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017530ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17532 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17533 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17534 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17535 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17536 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17537 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17538 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017539 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17540 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17541 LDAP v3.
17542 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17543 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017545ssl_f_serial : binary
17546 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17547 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17548 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017549
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017550ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17551 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17552 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17553 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17556 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17557 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17558 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560ssl_f_version : integer
17561 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17562 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17563
17564ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017565 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17566 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17567 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017569 Example :
17570 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17571 listen http-https
17572 bind :80
17573 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17574 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17575
17576ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17577 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17578 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17579
17580ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017581 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17583 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17584 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17585 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17586 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17587 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17588 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17589 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591ssl_fc_cipher : string
17592 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17593 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017594
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017595ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17596 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17597 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017598 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017599
17600ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17601 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17602 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017603 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017604
17605ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17606 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17607 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17608 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017609 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017610 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017611
17612ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17613 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17614 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017615 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017616
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017617ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17618 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17619 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17620 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17621
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017622ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17623 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17624 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17625 transport layer.
17626 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17627 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17628 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17629 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17630
17631ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17632 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17633 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17634 transport layer.
17635 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17636 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17637 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17638 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17639
17640ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17641 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17642 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17643 transport layer.
17644 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17645 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17646 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17647 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17648
17649ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17650 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17651 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17652 transport layer.
17653 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17654 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17655 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17656 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17657
17658ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17659 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17660 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17661 transport layer.
17662 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17663 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17664 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17665 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017667ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017668 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17669 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017670 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17671 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17672 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17673 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017674
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017675ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17676 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17677 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17678 wait until the handshake happened.
17679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017680ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17681 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017682 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17683 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017684 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017685 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017686
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017687ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017688 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017689 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17690 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017693 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017694 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17695 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17696 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17697 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17698 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17699 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17700 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702ssl_fc_protocol : string
17703 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17704 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017705
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017706ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017707 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017708 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17709 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017710
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017711ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17712 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17713 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17714 transport layer.
17715 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17716 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17717 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17718 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17719
17720ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17721 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17722 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17723 transport layer.
17724 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17725 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17726 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17727 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17728
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017729ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17730 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17731 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17732 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17735 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17736 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17737 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17738 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017739
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017740ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17741 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17742 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17743 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17744 BoringSSL.
17745
17746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747ssl_fc_sni : string
17748 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17749 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17750 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17751 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17752 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17753
17754 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17755 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17756 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017757 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017758 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017760 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17762 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017764ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17765 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17766 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017767
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017768ssl_s_der : binary
17769 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17770 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17771 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17772
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017773ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17774 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17775 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17776 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17777 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17778 does not support resumed sessions.
17779
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017780ssl_s_key_alg : string
17781 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17782 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17783 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17784
17785ssl_s_notafter : string
17786 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17787 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17788 transport layer.
17789
17790ssl_s_notbefore : string
17791 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17792 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17793 transport layer.
17794
17795ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17796 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17797 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17798 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17799 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17800 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17801 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017802 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17803 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017804 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17805 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17806 LDAP v3.
17807 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17808 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17809
17810ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17811 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17812 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17813 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17814 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17815 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17816 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017817 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17818 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017819 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17820 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17821 LDAP v3.
17822 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17823 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17824
17825ssl_s_serial : binary
17826 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17827 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17828 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17829
17830ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17831 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17832 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17833 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17834
17835ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17836 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17837 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17838 layer.
17839
17840ssl_s_version : integer
17841 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17842 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017843
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178447.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17848sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17849only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17850For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17851be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17852can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17853sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17854for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17855content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017857payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17860 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017862payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17863 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017864 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867req.len : integer
17868req_len : integer (deprecated)
17869 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17870 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17871 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17872 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17873 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17874 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17875 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17876 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017878req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17879 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017880 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17881 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17882 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17883 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017885 ACL alternatives :
17886 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017888req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17889 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17890 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17891 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17892 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017894 ACL alternatives :
17895 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017899req.proto_http : boolean
17900req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17901 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17902 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17903 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17904 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17905 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17906 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17907 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017909 Example:
17910 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17911 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17912 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017913 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017915req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17916rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17917 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17918 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17919 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17920 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17921 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17922 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17923 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17926 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17927 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17928 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17929 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17930 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017932 ACL derivatives :
17933 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935 Example :
17936 listen tse-farm
17937 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17938 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17939 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17940 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17941 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17942 persist rdp-cookie
17943 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17944 # This is only useful makes sense if
17945 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17946 stick-table type string size 204800
17947 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17948 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17949 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17952 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017954req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17955rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17956 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17957 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17958 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17959 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961 ACL derivatives :
17962 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017963
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017964req.ssl_alpn : string
17965 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17966 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17967 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17968 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17969 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17970 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017971 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017972
17973 Examples :
17974 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17975 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17976 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017977 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017978 default_backend bk_default
17979
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017980req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17981 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17982 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017983 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17984 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17985 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17986 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17987 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17990req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17991 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17992 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17993 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17994 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17995 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17996 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17997 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017999req.ssl_sni : string
18000req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18001 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18002 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18003 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18004 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18005 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018006 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18007 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18008 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18009 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18010 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18011 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18012 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18013 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18014 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018016 ACL derivatives :
18017 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019 Examples :
18020 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18021 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18022 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18023 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18024 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018025
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018026req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18027 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18028 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18029 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18030 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18031 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18032 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18033 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18034 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18035 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037req.ssl_ver : integer
18038req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18039 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18040 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18041 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18042 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18043 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18044 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18045 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018046 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018049 ACL derivatives :
18050 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018051
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018052res.len : integer
18053 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18054 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18055 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18056 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18057 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18058 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18059 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018060 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18063 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018064 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018065 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018066 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018067 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18070 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18071 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18072 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018073 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18074 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018076 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018077
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018078res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18079rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18080 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18081 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18082 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18083 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18084 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18085 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18086 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018088wait_end : boolean
18089 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18090 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018091 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018092 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18093 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018094 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018095 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18096 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018098 Examples :
18099 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18100 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18101 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018103 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18104 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18105 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18106 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18107 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18108 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18109 tcp-request content reject
18110
18111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181127.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113--------------------------------------
18114
18115It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18116This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18117data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18118its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18119HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18120content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18121to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18122more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18123response are indexed.
18124
18125base : string
18126 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18127 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18128 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18129 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18130 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18131 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18132 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18133 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18134
18135 ACL derivatives :
18136 base : exact string match
18137 base_beg : prefix match
18138 base_dir : subdir match
18139 base_dom : domain match
18140 base_end : suffix match
18141 base_len : length match
18142 base_reg : regex match
18143 base_sub : substring match
18144
18145base32 : integer
18146 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18147 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18148 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018149 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18150 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18151 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152
18153base32+src : binary
18154 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18155 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18156 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18157 per-URL counters.
18158
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018159capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18160 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18161 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18162 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18163
18164capture.req.method : string
18165 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18166 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18167 because it's allocated.
18168
18169capture.req.uri : string
18170 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18171 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18172 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18173 allocated.
18174
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018175capture.req.ver : string
18176 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18177 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18178 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18179
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018180capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18181 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18182 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18183 The first entry is an index of 0.
18184 See also: "capture response header"
18185
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018186capture.res.ver : string
18187 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18188 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18189 persistent flag.
18190
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018191req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018192 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18193 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18194 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018195
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018196req.body_param([<name>) : string
18197 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18198 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18199 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18200 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18201 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18202 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18203 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18204 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18205 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18206 given.
18207
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018208req.body_len : integer
18209 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18210 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018211 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18212 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018213
18214req.body_size : integer
18215 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018216 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18217 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219req.cook([<name>]) : string
18220cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18221 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18222 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18223 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18224 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18225 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18226 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18227 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18228 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18229
18230 ACL derivatives :
18231 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18232 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18233 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18234 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18235 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18236 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18237 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18238 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18241cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18242 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18243 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18246cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18247 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18248 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18249 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18250 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18253 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18254 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18255 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18256 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018257 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018258 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18259 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18260 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18261 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18264 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18265 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18266 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18267 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018268 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018271 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18272 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18273 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18274 with headers such as User-Agent.
18275
18276 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18277 found.
18278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18280 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18281 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018282 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18285 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18286 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018287 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18288 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018291 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18292 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18293 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18294 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18295 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18296 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18297 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18298
18299 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18300 found.
18301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018302 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18303 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18304 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018305 with -1 being the last one.
18306
18307 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18308 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310 ACL derivatives :
18311 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18312 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18313 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18314 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18315 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18316 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18317 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18318 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18319
18320req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18321hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18322 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18323 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018324 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18325 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18326 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18327
18328 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18329 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18330 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18331
18332 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333
18334req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18335hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18336 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18337 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18338 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7e2e49e2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010018339 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
18340 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
18341 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
18342 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
18343 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018344
18345 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18346
18347 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348
18349req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18350hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18351 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18352 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18353 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018354
18355 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18356
18357 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018359req.hdrs : string
18360 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18361 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18362 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18363 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18364
18365req.hdrs_bin : binary
18366 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18367 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18368 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18369 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18370 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18371 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18372
18373 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018374
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018375 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18376 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18379 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18380 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18381 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18382 basic auth is supported.
18383
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018384http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18385 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18386 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18387 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18388 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18390 basic auth is supported.
18391
18392 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018393 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18394 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18395 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18396 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018398http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018399 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18400 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18401 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018402
18403http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018404 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18405 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18406 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018407
18408http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018409 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18410 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18411 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018414 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18415 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18417 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018419method : integer + string
18420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18421 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18422 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18423 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18424 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18425 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18426 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018428 ACL derivatives :
18429 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431 Example :
18432 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18433 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18434 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018436path : string
18437 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18438 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18439 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18440 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18441 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018442 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445 ACL derivatives :
18446 path : exact string match
18447 path_beg : prefix match
18448 path_dir : subdir match
18449 path_dom : domain match
18450 path_end : suffix match
18451 path_len : length match
18452 path_reg : regex match
18453 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018454
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018455pathq : string
18456 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18457 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18458 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18459 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18460 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18461 result in both cases.
18462
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018463query : string
18464 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18465 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18466 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18467 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018468 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018469 which stops before the question mark.
18470
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018471req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18472 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18473 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18474 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18475 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477req.ver : string
18478req_ver : string (deprecated)
18479 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18480 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18481 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018483 ACL derivatives :
18484 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018485
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018486res.body : binary
18487 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18488 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018489 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18490
18491 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018492
18493res.body_len : integer
18494 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18495 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018496 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18497
18498 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018499
18500res.body_size : integer
18501 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18502 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18503 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18504 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018505 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18506
18507 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018508
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018509res.cache_hit : boolean
18510 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18511 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18512
18513res.cache_name : string
18514 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18515 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18516 empty string.
18517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518res.comp : boolean
18519 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18520 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18521 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523res.comp_algo : string
18524 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18525 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18526 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528res.cook([<name>]) : string
18529scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18530 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18531 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018532 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18533
18534 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536 ACL derivatives :
18537 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18540scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18541 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18542 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018543 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18544
18545 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018547res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18548scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18549 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18550 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018551 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18552
18553 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018555res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018556 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18557 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18558
18559 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18560 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18561
18562 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18563
18564 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018566res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018567 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18568 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18569
18570 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18571 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18572
18573 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18576shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018577 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18578 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18579
18580 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimeter. If
18581 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18582
18583 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585 ACL derivatives :
18586 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18587 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18588 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18589 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18590 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18591 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18592 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18593 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18594
18595res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18596shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018597 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18598 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18599
18600 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
18601 delimeter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
18602
18603 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18606shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018607 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18608 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18609
18610 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18611
18612 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018613
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018614res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18615 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18616 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18617 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018618 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18619
18620 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018622res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18623shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018624 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
18625 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18626
18627 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18628
18629 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018630
18631res.hdrs : string
18632 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18633 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18634 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018635 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18636
18637 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018638
18639res.hdrs_bin : binary
18640 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18641 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18642 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18643 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18644 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18645 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18646 (length of 0 for both).
18647
18648 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18649
18650 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18651 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653res.ver : string
18654resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18655 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018656 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
18657
18658 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660 ACL derivatives :
18661 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018663set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18664 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18665 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018666 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018667 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018669 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18670 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672status : integer
18673 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18674 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018675 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
18676
18677 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018678
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018679unique-id : string
18680 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18681 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18682 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18683 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18684 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18685 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687url : string
18688 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18689 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18690 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18691 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18692 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18693 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18694 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696 ACL derivatives :
18697 url : exact string match
18698 url_beg : prefix match
18699 url_dir : subdir match
18700 url_dom : domain match
18701 url_end : suffix match
18702 url_len : length match
18703 url_reg : regex match
18704 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706url_ip : ip
18707 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18708 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18709 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18710 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18711 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18712 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18713 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715url_port : integer
18716 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18717 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18718 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18719 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018720
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018721urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18722url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18724 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018725 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18726 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18727 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18728 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18730 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018731 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18732 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018734 ACL derivatives :
18735 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18736 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18737 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18738 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18739 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18740 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18741 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18742 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018743
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018745 Example :
18746 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18747 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18748 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18749 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018750
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018751urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18753 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18754 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018755
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018756url32 : integer
18757 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18758 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18759 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18760 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18761 is an unsigned integer.
18762
18763url32+src : binary
18764 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18765 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18766 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18767
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018768
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200187697.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018770---------------------------------------
18771
18772This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18773used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18774purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18775There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18776or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18777any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18778for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18779
18780internal.htx.data : integer
18781 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18782 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18783
18784internal.htx.free : integer
18785 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18786 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18787
18788internal.htx.free_data : integer
18789 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18790 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18791
18792internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18793 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18794 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18795 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18796
18797internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18798 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18799 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18800
18801internal.htx.size : integer
18802 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18803 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18804
18805internal.htx.used : integer
18806 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18807 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18808 direction.
18809
18810internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18811 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18812 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18813 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18814 of the special value :
18815 * head : The oldest inserted block
18816 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018817 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018818
18819internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18820 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18821 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18822 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18823 integer or one of the special value :
18824 * head : The oldest inserted block
18825 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018826 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018827
18828internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18829 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18830 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18831 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18832 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18833
18834 * head : The oldest inserted block
18835 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018836 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018837
18838internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18839 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18840 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18841 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18842 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18843
18844 * head : The oldest inserted block
18845 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018846 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018847
18848internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18849 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18850 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18851 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18852 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18853
18854 * head : The oldest inserted block
18855 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018856 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018857
18858internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18859 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18860 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18861 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18862 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18863
18864 * head : The oldest inserted block
18865 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018866 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018867
18868internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18869 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18870 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18871 it returns false.
18872
18873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200188747.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018875---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018877Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18878every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018879order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018881ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet2c9c0c92021-04-01 17:24:04 +020018882---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
18883FALSE always_false never match
18884HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
18885HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
18886HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
18887HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
18888HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18889HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18890HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18891LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
18892METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
18893METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
18894METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18895METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18896METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18897METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
18898METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
18899METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
18900RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
18901REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
18902TRUE always_true always match
18903WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18904---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018905
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189078. Logging
18908----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018909
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018910One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18911provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18912very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18913provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18914state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018915to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018916headers.
18917
18918In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18919about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18920send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18921
18922 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18923 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18924 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18925 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18926 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018927 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018928 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018929
18930The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18931allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18932as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18933while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18934real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18935delay.
18936
18937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189388.1. Log levels
18939---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018940
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018941TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018942source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018943HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18944in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18945track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18946syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18947about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018948
18949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189508.2. Log formats
18951----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018952
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018953HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018954and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18955slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18956options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018957
18958 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18959 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18960 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18961 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18962 extents.
18963
18964 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18965 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18966 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18967 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18968 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18969
18970 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18971 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18972 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18973 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18974 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18975
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018976 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18977 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18978 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18979 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18980
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018981 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18982
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018983Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18984specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18985field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18986servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18987always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18988identifier.
18989
18990Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18991 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18992 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18993 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18994 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18995
18996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189978.2.1. Default log format
18998-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018999
19000This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19001as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19002format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19003
19004 Example :
19005 listen www
19006 mode http
19007 log global
19008 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19009
19010 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19011 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19012 (www/HTTP)
19013
19014 Field Format Extract from the example above
19015 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19016 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19017 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19018 4 'to' to
19019 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19020 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19021
19022Detailed fields description :
19023 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19024 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19025 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19026 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19027 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19028 and processed the connection.
19029 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19030
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019031In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19032"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19033connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019035It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19036will eventually disappear.
19037
19038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190398.2.2. TCP log format
19040---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019041
19042The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19043is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19044information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19045counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19046emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19047environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19048the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19049sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019050specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19051not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19052fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19053marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019054
19055 Example :
19056 frontend fnt
19057 mode tcp
19058 option tcplog
19059 log global
19060 default_backend bck
19061
19062 backend bck
19063 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19064
19065 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19066 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19067 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19068
19069 Field Format Extract from the example above
19070 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19071 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19072 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19073 4 frontend_name fnt
19074 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19075 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19076 7 bytes_read* 212
19077 8 termination_state --
19078 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19079 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19080
19081Detailed fields description :
19082 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019083 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19084 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19085 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019086 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019087 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019088 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019089
19090 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019091 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19092 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19093 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019094
19095 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19096 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19097 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019098 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19099 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19100 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19101 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019102
19103 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19104 and processed the connection.
19105
19106 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19107 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19108 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19109 applications.
19110
19111 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19112 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19113 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19114 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19115 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19116
19117 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19118 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19119 See "Timers" below for more details.
19120
19121 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19122 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19123 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19124 "Timers" below for more details.
19125
19126 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019127 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019128 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19129 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19130 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19131 details.
19132
19133 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19134 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19135 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19136 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19137 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19138
19139 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19140 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19141 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19142 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19143 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19144 for more details.
19145
19146 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019147 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019148 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19149 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19150 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019151 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019152
19153 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19154 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19155 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19156 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19157 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19158 caused by a denial of service attack.
19159
19160 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19161 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19162 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19163 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19164 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19165 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19166 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19167 denial of service attack.
19168
19169 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19170 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19171 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19172 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19173 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19174 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19175 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19176 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19177 be processed than on other servers.
19178
19179 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19180 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19181 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19182 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19183 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19184 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19185 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19186 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19187 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19188 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19189 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19190 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19191 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19192
19193 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19194 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19195 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19196 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19197 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19198 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019199 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019200 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19201
19202 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19203 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19204 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19205 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19206 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19207 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019208 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019209 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19210 occurs.
19211
19212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192138.2.3. HTTP log format
19214----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019215
19216The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19217is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19218the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19219are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19220emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19221generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19222"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19223which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019224frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19225is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019226
19227Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19228slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19229with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19230
19231 Example :
19232 frontend http-in
19233 mode http
19234 option httplog
19235 log global
19236 default_backend bck
19237
19238 backend static
19239 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19240
19241 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19242 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19243 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019244 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246 Field Format Extract from the example above
19247 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19248 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019249 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019250 4 frontend_name http-in
19251 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019252 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019253 7 status_code 200
19254 8 bytes_read* 2750
19255 9 captured_request_cookie -
19256 10 captured_response_cookie -
19257 11 termination_state ----
19258 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19259 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19260 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19261 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19262 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264Detailed fields description :
19265 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019266 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19267 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19268 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019269 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019270 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019271 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019272
19273 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019274 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19275 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19276 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019277
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019278 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19279 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280
19281 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19282 and processed the connection.
19283
19284 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19285 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19286 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19287
19288 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19289 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19290 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19291 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19292 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19293 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019295 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19296 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19297 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019298 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019299 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19300 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019301 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19302 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019303
19304 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19305 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019306 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019307
19308 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19309 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019310 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19311 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019312
19313 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19314 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19315 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19316 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19317 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019318 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19319 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019320
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019321 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19322 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19323 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19324 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19325 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19326 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19327 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019328 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019329
19330 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19331 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19332 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19333
19334 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19335 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019336 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019337 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19338 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19339 overflowing.
19340
19341 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19342 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19343 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19344 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19345 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19346 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19347 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19348 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19349
19350 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19351 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19352 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19353 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19354 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19355 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19356 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19357 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19358
19359 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19360 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19361 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19362 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19363 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19364 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19365 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19366
19367 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019368 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019369 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19370 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19371 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019372 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019373 system.
19374
19375 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19376 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19377 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19378 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19379 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19380 caused by a denial of service attack.
19381
19382 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19383 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19384 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19385 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19386 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19387 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19388 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19389 denial of service attack.
19390
19391 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19392 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19393 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19394 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19395 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19396 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19397 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19398 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19399 processed than on other servers.
19400
19401 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19402 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19403 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19404 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19405 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19406 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19407 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19408 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19409 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19410 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19411 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19412 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19413 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19414
19415 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19416 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19417 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19418 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19419 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19420 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019421 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019422 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19423
19424 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19425 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19426 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19427 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19428 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19429 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019430 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019431 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19432 occurs.
19433
19434 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19435 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19436 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19437 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19438 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19439 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19440 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19441 cookies" below for more details.
19442
19443 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19444 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19445 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19446 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19447 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19448 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19449 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19450 and cookies" below for more details.
19451
19452 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19453 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19454 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19455 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19456 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19457 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19458 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19459 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19460
19461
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200194628.2.4. Custom log format
19463------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019464
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019465The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019466mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019468HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019469Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19470separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19471prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19472
19473Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19474variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019475("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019476
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019477If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019478as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019479less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19480the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19481
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019482Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19483"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19484delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19485preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019486
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019487Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19488'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19489https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19490such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019492Flags are :
19493 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019494 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019495 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19496 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019497
19498 Example:
19499
19500 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19501 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19502
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019503 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19504
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019505At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19506
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019507 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19508 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019509
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019510the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019512 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19513 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19514 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019515
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019516and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19517
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019518 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19519 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019520
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019521Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19522
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019523 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019524 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019525 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19526 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19527 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019528 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19529 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19530 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019531 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019532 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdebf9f0f942020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019533 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019534 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019535 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19536 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019537 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019538 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019539 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019540 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019541 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019542 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019543 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019544 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19545 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19546 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19547 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19548 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019549 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019550 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019551 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019552 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019553 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019554 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19555 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019556 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19557 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19558 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019559 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019560 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19561 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019562 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019563 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19564 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19565 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019566 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019567 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019568 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19569 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19570 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19571 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019572 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019573 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019574 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019575 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019576 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019577 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019578 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19579 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19580 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019581 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019582 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19583 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019584 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019585 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19586 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019587 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019588 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019589 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019590 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019591
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019592 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019593
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019594
195958.2.5. Error log format
19596-----------------------
19597
19598When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19599protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19600By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19601"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019602will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019603logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19604
19605The format looks like this :
19606
19607 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19608 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19609 Connection error during SSL handshake
19610
19611 Field Format Extract from the example above
19612 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19613 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19614 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19615 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19616 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19617
19618These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19619failures.
19620
19621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196228.3. Advanced logging options
19623-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019624
19625Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19626just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19627options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19628for more information about their usage.
19629
19630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196318.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19632------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019633
19634It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19635haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19636commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19637monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19638ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19639
19640 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19641 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19642 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19643 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19644
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019645 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19646 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019647
19648 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19649 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19650 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19651
19652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19654----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019655
19656The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19657what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19658or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019659"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019660just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19661log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19662after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19663is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19664with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19665with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19666
19667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19669------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019670
19671Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19672for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19673"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19674retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19675raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19676a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19677file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19678you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19679"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19680
19681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19683--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019684
19685Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19686multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19687them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19688"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19689logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19690error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19691and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19692too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19693useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19694alternative.
19695
19696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196978.4. Timing events
19698------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019699
19700Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19701reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19702the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19703frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019704mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19705addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19706
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019707Timings events in HTTP mode:
19708
19709 first request 2nd request
19710 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19711 t tr t tr ...
19712 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19713 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19714 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19715 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019716 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019717 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19718
19719Timings events in TCP mode:
19720
19721 TCP session
19722 |<----------------->|
19723 t t
19724 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19725 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19726 |<------ Tt ------->|
19727
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019728 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019729 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019730 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19731 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19732 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019733 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019734 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19735 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19736 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19737 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019739 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19740 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19741 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019742 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19743 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19744 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19745 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19746 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19747 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019748
19749 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19750 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19751 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19752 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19753 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19754 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19755 request typed by hand during a test.
19756
19757 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19758 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019759 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019760 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19761 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19762 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19763 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019764
19765 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19766 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19767 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19768 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19769 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19770
19771 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19772 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19773 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19774 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19775 connection never established.
19776
19777 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19778 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19779 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19780 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19781 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19782 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19783 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19784 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19785 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19786 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19787 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19788
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019789 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19790 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19791 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19792 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19793 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19794 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19795
19796 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19797
19798 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19799 "Ta" can never be negative.
19800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019801 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19802 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019803 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19804 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019805 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019807 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019808
19809 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019810 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19811 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019812
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019813 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19814 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19815 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19816 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19817 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19818 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19819 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19820 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19821
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019822These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19823protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19824that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019825due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19826"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19827that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019828
19829Most common cases :
19830
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019831 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19832 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19833 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19834 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19835 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19836 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19837 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19838 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19839 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19840 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19841 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019842 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019843
19844 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19845 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19846 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19847 of ms on remote networks.
19848
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019849 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19850 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19851 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019853 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19854 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19855 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19856 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19857 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19858 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19859 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19860 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19861 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019862
19863Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019865 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019866 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019867 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019869 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019870 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19871 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019873 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019874 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19875 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19876 flags.
19877
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019878 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19879 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019880 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19881 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19882 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19883 the client connection was maintained open.
19884
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019885 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019886 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019887 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019888 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19889
19890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198918.5. Session state at disconnection
19892-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019893
19894TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19895"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
198962-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19897each of which has a special meaning :
19898
19899 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19900 session to terminate :
19901
19902 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19903
19904 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19905 server explicitly refused it.
19906
19907 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19908 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19909 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19910 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019911 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019912
19913 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19914 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915
19916 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19917 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19918 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19919 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19920 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19921
19922 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19923 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19924 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19925 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19926 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19927
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019928 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19929 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19930
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019931 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19932 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19933 backup connections when going up.
19934
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019935 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019937 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19938 send or receive data.
19939
19940 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19941 send or receive data.
19942
19943 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19944 with nothing left in the buffers.
19945
19946 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19947
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019948 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19950
19951 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19952 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19953 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19954 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19955 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19956
19957 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19958 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19959
19960 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19961 server (HTTP only).
19962
19963 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19964
19965 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19966 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19967 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19968
19969 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19970 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19971 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19972
19973 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19974
19975 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19976 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19977
19978 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19979 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19980 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19981
19982 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19983 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019984 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19985 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019986
19987 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19988 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19989 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19990 another server.
19991
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019992 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019993 server.
19994
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019995 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19996 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19997 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19998 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19999
20000 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20001 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20002 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20003 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20004
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020005 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20006 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20007 "use-server" rule).
20008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020009 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20010
20011 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20012 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20013
20014 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20015
20016 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20017 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20018 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20019
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020020 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20021 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020022 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020023 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20024 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20025
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20027
20028 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20029 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20030
20031 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20032
20033 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20034
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020035The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20036was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020037helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20038starvation, attacks, etc...
20039
20040The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20041alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20042easier finding and understanding.
20043
20044 Flags Reason
20045
20046 -- Normal termination.
20047
20048 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20049 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20050 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20051 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20052
20053 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20054 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20055 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20056 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20057 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20058 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020060 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20061 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020062 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063
20064 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20065 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20066 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20067
20068 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20069 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20070 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20071 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20072 the server takes too long to respond.
20073
20074 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20075 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20076 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20077 long a time to respond.
20078
20079 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20080 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20081 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20082 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020083 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20084 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020085
20086 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20087 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20088 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20089 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20090 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020091 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020092 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20093 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20094 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20095 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20096 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20097 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20098 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20099 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020100 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020101 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20102 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20103 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020104
20105 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20106 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020107 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20108 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20109 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20110 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020111
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020112 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20113 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020115 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020116 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20117 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020118 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020119 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20120 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20121
20122 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20123 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20124 503 or 504 here.
20125
20126 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20127 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20128 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20129 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20130 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20131
20132 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20133 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020134 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020135 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20136 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20137
20138 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20139 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20140 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20141 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20142 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20143 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20144 between haproxy and the server.
20145
20146 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20147 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20148 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20149 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20150 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20151 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20152 solution is to fix the application.
20153
20154 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20155 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20156 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20157 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20158 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20159 external attacks.
20160
20161 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020162 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020163 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20165 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20166
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020167 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20168 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20169 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020170 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020171 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020172
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020173 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20174 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20175 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20176 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020177 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20178 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20179 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20180 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20181 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020182
20183 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20184 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20185 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20186 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20187
20188 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20189 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20190 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20191 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20192
20193 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20194 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20195 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20196 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20197
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020198The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20199persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20200important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20201re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20202
20203 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20204
20205 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20206 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20207 set on a GET request.
20208
20209 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20210 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020211 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020212 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20213
20214 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20215 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20216 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20217
20218 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20219 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20220 already got a cookie.
20221
20222 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20223 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20224 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20225 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20226 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20227
20228 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20229 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20230 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20231
20232 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20233 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20234 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20235
20236 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20237 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20238
20239 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20240 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20241 then advertised in the response.
20242
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202448.6. Non-printable characters
20245-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020246
20247In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20248consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20249converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20250prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20251being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20252escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20253is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20254'}' when logging headers.
20255
20256Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20257issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20258containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20259
20260Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20261the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20262performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20263
20264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202658.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20266---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267
20268Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20269achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020270section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020271cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20272the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20273the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020274locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020275not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20276user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20277a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20278wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20279
20280 Examples :
20281 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20282 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20283
20284 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20285 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20286
20287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20289---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020290
20291Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20292proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20293the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20294server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20295
20296Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20297response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020298section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020299
20300It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020301time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20302appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020303are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20304and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20305follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20306request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20307in the logs.
20308
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020309As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20310frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20311an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020313 Example :
20314 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20315 listen proxy-out
20316 mode http
20317 option httplog
20318 option logasap
20319 log global
20320 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20321
20322 # log the name of the virtual server
20323 capture request header Host len 20
20324
20325 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20326 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20327
20328 # log the beginning of the referrer
20329 capture request header Referer len 20
20330
20331 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20332 capture response header Server len 20
20333
20334 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20335 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020337 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020338 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20339
20340 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20341 capture response header Via len 20
20342
20343 # log the URL location during a redirection
20344 capture response header Location len 20
20345
20346 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20347 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20348 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20349 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20350 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20351
20352 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20353 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20354 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20355 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020356 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020357
20358 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20359 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20360 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20361 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20362 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020363 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020364
20365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203668.9. Examples of logs
20367---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020368
20369These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20370them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20371reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20372
20373 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20374 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20375 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20376
20377 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20378 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20379
20380 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20381 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20382 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20383
20384 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20385 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20386
20387 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20388 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20389 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20390
20391 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020392 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020393 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20394 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20395
20396 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20397 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20398 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20399
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020400 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20401 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20402 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20403 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20404 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20405 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020406
20407 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020408 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020409
20410 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20411 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20412 Nothing was sent to any server.
20413
20414 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20415 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20416
20417 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20418 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020419 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020420 send a 408 return code to the client.
20421
20422 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20423 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20424
20425 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20426 5 seconds ("c----").
20427
20428 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20429 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020430 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020431
20432 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020433 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020434 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20435 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20436 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20437 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20438 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020439
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020440
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200204419. Supported filters
20442--------------------
20443
20444Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20445accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20446unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20447
20448See also : "filter"
20449
204509.1. Trace
20451----------
20452
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020453filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020454
20455 Arguments:
20456 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20457 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20458
20459 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20460 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20461 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20462 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020464 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020465 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20466 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20467 amount of the parsed data.
20468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020469 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020470
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020471This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20472callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20473information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20474filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20475
20476Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20477tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20478a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20479
20480
204819.2. HTTP compression
20482---------------------
20483
20484filter compression
20485
20486The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20487keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020488when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20489fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20490done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20491explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20492filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20493listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20494order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020495
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020496See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20497 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020498
20499
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200205009.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20501--------------------------------------------
20502
20503filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20504
20505 Arguments :
20506
20507 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20508 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20509 parsed.
20510
20511 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20512 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20513 part must be placed in its own scope.
20514
20515The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20516external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020517streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020518exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20519also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20520
20521SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20522the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20523
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020524For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020525"doc/SPOE.txt".
20526
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100205279.4. Cache
20528----------
20529
20530filter cache <name>
20531
20532 Arguments :
20533
20534 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20535
20536The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20537"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020538cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020539other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20540case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20541is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20542filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020543listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20544order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020545
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020546See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20547 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20548
20549
205509.5. Fcgi-app
20551-------------
20552
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020553filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020554
20555 Arguments :
20556
20557 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20558
20559The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20560request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20561reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20562used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20563implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20564used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20565fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20566used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20567order.
20568
20569See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20570 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20571
20572
2057310. FastCGI applications
20574-------------------------
20575
20576HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20577feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20578the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20579FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20580servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20581FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20582backend.
20583
20584HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20585application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20586connection.
20587
2058810.1. Setup
20589-----------
20590
2059110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20592--------------------------
20593
20594fcgi-app <name>
20595 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20596 document root must be defined.
20597
20598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20599 Declare or complete an access list.
20600
20601 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20602 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20603 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20604 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20605 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20606
20607docroot <path>
20608 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20609 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20610 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20611
20612index <script-name>
20613 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20614 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20615 is an optional setting.
20616
20617 Example :
20618 index index.php
20619
20620log-stderr global
20621log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020622 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020623 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20624
20625 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20626 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20627
20628pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20629 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20630 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20631 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20632
20633 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20634 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20635 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20636 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20637
20638 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20639 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20640
20641path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020642 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020643 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20644 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20645 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20646 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20647 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20648 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20649 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020650
20651 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020652 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020653 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20654 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20655 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20656 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020657
20658 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020659 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20660 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020661
20662option get-values
20663no option get-values
20664 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20665
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020666 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020667 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20668
20669 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20670 application will accept.
20671
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020672 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20673 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020674
20675 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020676 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020677 option is disabled.
20678
20679 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20680 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20681 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20682 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20683 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20684 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20685
20686option keep-conn
20687no option keep-conn
20688 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20689 sending a response.
20690
20691 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20692 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20693
20694option max-reqs <reqs>
20695 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20696 accept.
20697
20698 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20699 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20700 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20701 to 1.
20702
20703option mpxs-conns
20704no option mpxs-conns
20705 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20706
20707 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20708 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20709
20710set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20711 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20712 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20713 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20714 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20715
20716 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20717 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20718 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20719
20720 Example :
20721 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20722 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20723
20724 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20725
20726
2072710.1.2. Proxy section
20728---------------------
20729
20730use-fcgi-app <name>
20731 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20732
20733 Arguments :
20734 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20735
20736 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20737 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20738 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20739 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20740 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20741
20742 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20743 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20744 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20745 application are evaluated.
20746
20747
2074810.1.3. Example
20749---------------
20750
20751 frontend front-http
20752 mode http
20753 bind *:80
20754 bind *:
20755
20756 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20757 default_backend back-static
20758
20759 backend back-static
20760 mode http
20761 server www A.B.C.D:80
20762
20763 backend back-dynamic
20764 mode http
20765 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20766 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20767
20768 fcgi-app php-fpm
20769 log-stderr global
20770 option keep-conn
20771
20772 docroot /var/www/my-app
20773 index index.php
20774 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20775
20776
2077710.2. Default parameters
20778------------------------
20779
20780A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20781the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020782script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020783applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20784
20785 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20786 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20787 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20788 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20789 | | |
20790 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20791 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20792 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20793 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20794 | | application. |
20795 | | |
20796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20797 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20798 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20799 | | |
20800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20801 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20802 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20803 | | the application's configuration. |
20804 | | |
20805 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20806 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20807 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20808 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20809 | | |
20810 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20811 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20812 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20813 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20814 | | be defined. |
20815 | | |
20816 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20817 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20818 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20819 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20820 | | is not set too. |
20821 | | |
20822 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20823 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20824 | | set. |
20825 | | |
20826 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20827 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20828 | | the request. |
20829 | | |
20830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20831 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20832 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20833 | | |
20834 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20835 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20836 | | script to process the request. |
20837 | | |
20838 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20839 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20840 | | |
20841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20842 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20843 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20844 | | |
20845 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20846 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20847 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20848 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20849 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20850 | | |
20851 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20852 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20853 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20854 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20855 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20856 | | side. |
20857 | | |
20858 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20859 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20860 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20861 | | connected to. |
20862 | | |
20863 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20864 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20865 | | |
20866 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20867 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20868 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20869 | | |
20870 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20871
20872
2087310.3. Limitations
20874------------------
20875
20876The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20877way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20878during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20879establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20880application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20881or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20882message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20883these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20884and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20885
20886Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20887request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20888requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20889
20890About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20891into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20892fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20893"http-request" ones.
20894
20895Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20896FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20897processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20898must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20899here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020901/*
20902 * Local variables:
20903 * fill-column: 79
20904 * End:
20905 */